blob: f33c97552c7b97a8a48bb74e46a5cffe6d2c94e1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200972 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900973 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974 - gid
975 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100976 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200977 - h1-case-adjust
978 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100979 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100980 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100981 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200982 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200984 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100985 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100987 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100988 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200989 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200990 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200991 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100993 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200995 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100996 - presetenv
997 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - uid
999 - ulimit-n
1000 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001001 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001002 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001003 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001004 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001005 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - ssl-default-bind-options
1009 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001010 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001011 - ssl-default-server-options
1012 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001013 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001014 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001015 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001016 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 - 51degrees-data-file
1018 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001019 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001020 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001021 - wurfl-data-file
1022 - wurfl-information-list
1023 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001024 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001025 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001028 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001029 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001031 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001032 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001033 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001034 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001035 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001036 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001037 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001038 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 - noepoll
1040 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001041 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001042 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001043 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001044 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001045 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001046 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001047 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001048 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001049 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001050 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001051 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001052 - tune.buffers.limit
1053 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001054 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001055 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001056 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001057 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001058 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001059 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001060 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001061 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001062 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001063 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001064 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001065 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001066 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001067 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001068 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1069 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001070 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001071 - tune.maxaccept
1072 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001073 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001074 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001075 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001076 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1077 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001078 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1079 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001080 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001081 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001082 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001083 - tune.sndbuf.client
1084 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001085 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001086 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001087 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001088 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001089 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001090 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001091 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001092 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001093 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001094 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001095 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1096 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1097 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001098 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1099 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001100
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001103 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107------------------------------------
1108
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001109ca-base <dir>
1110 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001111 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1112 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1113 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001114
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115chroot <jail dir>
1116 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1117 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1118 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1119 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1120 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001121 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001123cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1124 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1125 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1126 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1127 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1128 set. These sets have the format
1129
1130 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1131
1132 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001134 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1135 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001136 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1137 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001138 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1139 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1140 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1141 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1142 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1143 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1144 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1145 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1146 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1147 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001148
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001149 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1150 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1151 on the machine's word size.
1152
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001153 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1155 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1156 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1157 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1158 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1159 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001160
1161 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1163
1164 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1165 # first 4 CPUs
1166
1167 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1168 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1169 # word size.
1170
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001171 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001172 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001173 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1174 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1176
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001177 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1178 # and so on.
1179 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1181 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001184 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1185 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1186 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1187
1188 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1189 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1190 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1191
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001192 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1193 # and a thread range.
1194 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1195 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1196 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1197
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001198crt-base <dir>
1199 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001200 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1201 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203daemon
1204 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1205 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001206 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1207 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001209default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1210 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1211 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1212 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1213 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1214 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1215 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1216 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1217 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1218 not start with a slash ('/'):
1219 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1220 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1221
1222 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1223 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1224 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1225 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1226 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1227 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1228 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1229 each of them.
1230
1231 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1233 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1234 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1235 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1236 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1237 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1238 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1239
1240 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1242 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1243 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1244 made easily relocatable.
1245
1246 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1247 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1248 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1249 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1250 consistent across all configuration files.
1251
1252 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1253 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1254 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1255 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1256 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1257 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1258 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1259 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1260
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001261deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1262 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001263 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001264
1265deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001267 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1268
1269deviceatlas-separator <char>
1270 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1271 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1272
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001273deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001274 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1275 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1276 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001277
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001278expose-experimental-directives
1279 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1280 the config file will be rejected.
1281
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001282external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001283 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1284 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001285 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1286 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1287 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1288 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1289 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001292 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1294 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001295 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1296 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001298
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001299group <group name>
1300 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1301 See also "gid" and "user".
1302
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001303hard-stop-after <time>
1304 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1305
1306 Arguments :
1307 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1308 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1309 SIGUSR1 signal.
1310
1311 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1312 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1313 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1314
1315 Example:
1316 global
1317 hard-stop-after 30s
1318
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001319h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1320 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1321 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1322 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1323 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001324 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001325 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1326 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1327 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1328 specified in a proxy.
1329
1330 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1331 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1332 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1333 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1334 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1335 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1336 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1337
1338 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1339 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1340 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1341 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1342 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1343
1344 Example:
1345 global
1346 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1347
1348 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1349 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1350
1351h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1352 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1353 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1354 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1355 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1356 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1357 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1358 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1359 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1360
1361 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1362 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1363 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1364
1365 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1366 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1367
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001368insecure-fork-wanted
1369 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1370 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1371 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1372 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1373 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1374 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1375 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1376 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1377 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1378 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1379 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1380 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1381 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1382 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1383 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1384 disable it.
1385
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001386insecure-setuid-wanted
1387 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1388 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1389 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1390 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1391 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1392 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1393 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1394 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1395 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1396 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1397 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1398 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1399 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1400 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1401
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001402issuers-chain-path <dir>
1403 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1404 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1405 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1406 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1407 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1408 "issuers-chain-path".
1409 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1410 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1411 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1412 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1413 will share the chain in memory.
1414
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001415localpeer <name>
1416 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1417 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1418 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1419 the configuration parsing.
1420
1421 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1422 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1423
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001424log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001425 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001426 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001427 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001428 configured with "log global".
1429
1430 <address> can be one of:
1431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001432 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001433 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1434 port).
1435
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001436 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1437 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1438 port).
1439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001440 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001441 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1442 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001443 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001444
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001445 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1446 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1447 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1448 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1449 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1450 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1451 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1452 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1453 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1454 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1455 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1456 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1457 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1458 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001459 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1460 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001461
1462 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1463 "fd@2", see above.
1464
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001465 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1466 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1467 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1468 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1469 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1472 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001473
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001474 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1475 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1476 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1477 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1478 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1479 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1480 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1481 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1482 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1483 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1485 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001486
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001487 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1488 one of the following :
1489
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001490 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1491 field is stripped. This is the default.
1492 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1493 rfc3164.
1494
1495 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001496 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1497
1498 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1499 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1500
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001501 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1502 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1503 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1504 designed to be used with a local log server.
1505
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001506 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1507 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1508 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1509 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1510 logger consumes.
1511
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001512 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1513 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1514 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1515 used with a local log server.
1516
1517 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1518 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1519 designed to be used with a local log server.
1520
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001521 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1522 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1523 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1524 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1525
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001526 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1527 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1528 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1529 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1530 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1531
1532 <sample_size>
1533 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1534 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1535 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1536 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1537 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1538
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1544
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001545 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1546 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1547 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1548 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001549
1550 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001551 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1552 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1553 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1554 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1555 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1556 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001557
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001558 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001560log-send-hostname [<string>]
1561 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1562 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1563 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1564 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1565 the logs.
1566
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001567log-tag <string>
1568 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1569 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1570 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001571 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001572
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001573lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001574 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1575 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1576 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1577 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1578 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1579 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001580 used multiple times.
1581
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001582lua-load-per-thread <file>
1583 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1584 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1585 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1586 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1587 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1588 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1589 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1590 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1591 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1592 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1593 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1594 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1595 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1596 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1597 times.
1598
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001599lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1600 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1601 variable.
1602 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1603 to "path".
1604
1605 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1606 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1607 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1608 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1609 will be checked earlier.
1610
1611 As an example by specifying the following path:
1612
1613 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1614 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1615
1616 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1617 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1618 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1619 paths if that does not exist either.
1620
1621 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1622 documentation.
1623
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001624master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001625 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1626 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1627 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001628 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001629 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1630 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001631 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1632 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1633 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1634 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1635 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001636
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001637 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001638
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001639mworker-max-reloads <number>
1640 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001641 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001642 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1643 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1644 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1645
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001646nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001647 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1648 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1649 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001650 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1651 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001652 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1653 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1654 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001655
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001656nbthread <number>
1657 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001658 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1659 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1660 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1661 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1662 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001663 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1664 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1665 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1666 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1667 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1668 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1669 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001670
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001671numa-cpu-mapping
1672 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1673 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1674 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1675 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1676 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1677 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1678 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1679 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1680 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001682pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001683 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1684 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1685 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1686 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001688pp2-never-send-local
1689 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1690 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1691 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1692 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1693 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1694 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1695 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1696 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1697 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1698 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1699 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1700
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001701presetenv <name> <value>
1702 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1703 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1704 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1705 and "unsetenv".
1706
1707resetenv [<name> ...]
1708 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1709 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1710 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1711 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1712 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1713 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1714 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1715 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001717stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001718 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1719 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1720 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1721 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1722 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1723 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001724 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001725 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1726 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1727 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1728 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001729
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001730server-state-base <directory>
1731 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001732 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1733 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001734
1735server-state-file <file>
1736 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1737 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1738 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1739 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1740 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1741 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1742 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1743 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1745 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001746
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001747set-var <var-name> <expr>
1748 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1749 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1750 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1751 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1752 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1753 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1754 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1755 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1756 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1757
1758 Example:
1759 global
1760 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1761 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1762 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1763
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001764setenv <name> <value>
1765 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1766 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1767 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1768 and "unsetenv".
1769
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001770set-dumpable
1771 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001772 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1773 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1774 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1775 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1776 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1777 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1778 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1779 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1780 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1781 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1782 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1783 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1784 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1785 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1786 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1787 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1788 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001789
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001790ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1792 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001793 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001794 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001795 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1796 information and recommendations see e.g.
1797 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1798 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1799 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1800 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001801
1802ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1804 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1805 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1806 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1807 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001808 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1809 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1810 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001811 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001812
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001813ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1815 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1816 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1817 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1819
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001820ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1822 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1823 keyword to see available options.
1824
1825 Example:
1826 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001827 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001828
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001829ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1831 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001832 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001833 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001834 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1835 information and recommendations see e.g.
1836 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1837 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1838 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1839 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1840 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001841
1842ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1844 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1845 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1846 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1847 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001848 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1849 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1850 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1851 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001852
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001853ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1855 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1856 keyword to see available options.
1857
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001858ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1860 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1861 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001863 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001864 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1865 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1866 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1867 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1869 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1870 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1871
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001872ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1873 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1874 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001875 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001876 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001877 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1878
1879 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001880
1881 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1882 and won't try to remove them.
1883
1884 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1885
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001886ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001887 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001888 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1889 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1904
1905 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1906 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1907 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1908 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1909 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1910 bind configuration..
1911
1912 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1913 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1914 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1915 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1916 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1917 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1918 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1919 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1920
1921 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1922
1923 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1924 a cert bundle.
1925
1926 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1927 separately in several "crt".
1928
1929 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1930 since files are loading separately.
1931
1932 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1933 required to commit them.
1934
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001935 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001937
1938 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1939
1940 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1941
1942 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1943 not provided in the PEM file.
1944
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001945 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1946 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1947
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948 The default behavior is "all".
1949
1950 Example:
1951 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1952 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1953 ssl-load-extra-files none
1954
1955 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1956
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001957ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1958 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1959 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1960 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1961
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001962ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001963 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001964 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1965 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1966 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1967 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1968 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1969 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001970 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001972stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1973 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1974 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1975 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001976 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001977 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1980 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1981 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001982
1983stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1984 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1985 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001986 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001987
1988stats maxconn <connections>
1989 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1990 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001992uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001993 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001994 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1995 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1996 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1997
1998ulimit-n <number>
1999 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2000 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2001 option.
2002
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002003unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2004 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2005
2006 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2007 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2008 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2009 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2010 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
2011 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
2012 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2013 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2014 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2015 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2016
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002017unsetenv [<name> ...]
2018 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2019 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2020 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2021 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2022 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2023 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2024 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002026user <user name>
2027 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2028 See also "uid" and "group".
2029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002030node <name>
2031 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2032
2033 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2034 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2035 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2036 traffic.
2037
2038description <text>
2039 Add a text that describes the instance.
2040
2041 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2042 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2043 "<" and ">" characters.
2044
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100204551degrees-data-file <file path>
2046 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002047 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002048
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002050 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2051
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000205251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002053 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2054 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2055 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2056
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002057 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2059
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2062 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2063
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002064 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2065 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2066
206751degrees-cache-size <number>
2068 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2069 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2070 By default, this cache is disabled.
2071
2072 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002073 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2074
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002075wurfl-data-file <file path>
2076 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2077 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2078
2079 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2080 with USE_WURFL=1.
2081
2082wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2083 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2084 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2085 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2086
2087 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2088
2089 Valid WURFL properties are:
2090 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2091
2092 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2093 device.
2094
2095 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2096 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2097
2098 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2099 particular web request.
2100
2101 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2102 used Libwurfl API version.
2103
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002104 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2105 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2106
2107 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2108 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2109
2110 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2111
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002112 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2113 with USE_WURFL=1.
2114
2115wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2116 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2117 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2118
2119 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2120 with USE_WURFL=1.
2121
2122wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2123 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2124 thus before the chroot.
2125
2126 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2127 with USE_WURFL=1.
2128
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002129wurfl-cache-size <size>
2130 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2131 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002132 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002133 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002134
2135 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2136 with USE_WURFL=1.
2137
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002138strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002139 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2140 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2141 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2142 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2143 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021453.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002146-----------------------
2147
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002148busy-polling
2149 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2150 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2151 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2152 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2153 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2154 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2155 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2156 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2157 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2158 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2159 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2160 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2161 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2162 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2163 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2164 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2165 "poll" pollers.
2166
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002167 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2168 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2169 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2170
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002171max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2172 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2173 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2174 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2175 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2176 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2177 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2178 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2179 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2180
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002181maxconn <number>
2182 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2183 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2184 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002185 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2186 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2187 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2188 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002189 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2190 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2191 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2192 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2193 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2194 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002195
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002196maxconnrate <number>
2197 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2198 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2199 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2200 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2201 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2202 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2203 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2204 fairness.
2205
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002206maxcomprate <number>
2207 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002209 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2210 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2211 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002212 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002213 default value.
2214
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002215maxcompcpuusage <number>
2216 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2217 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2218 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2219 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2220 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2221 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2222 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2223 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2224
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002225maxpipes <number>
2226 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2227 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2228 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2229 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2230 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2231 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2232
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002233maxsessrate <number>
2234 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2235 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2236 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2237 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2238 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2239 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2240 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2241 fairness.
2242
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002243maxsslconn <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2245 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2246 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2247 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2248 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2249 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2250 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002251 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2252 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2253 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2254 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2255 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2256 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2257 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002258
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002259maxsslrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2261 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2262 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2263 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2264 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2265 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2266 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2267 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2268 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2269 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2270
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002271maxzlibmem <number>
2272 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2273 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2274 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002275 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2276 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2277 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002279noepoll
2280 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2281 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002282 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002283
2284nokqueue
2285 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2286 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2287 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2288
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002289noevports
2290 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2291 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2292 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2293 also "nopoll".
2294
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002295nopoll
2296 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2297 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2300 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002302nosplice
2303 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002304 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002305 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002306 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002307 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2308 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2309 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2310 "option splice-response".
2311
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002312nogetaddrinfo
2313 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2314 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2315
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002316noreuseport
2317 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2318 command line argument "-dR".
2319
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002320profiling.memory { on | off }
2321 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2322 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2323 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2324 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2325 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2326 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2327 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2328 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2329 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2330
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002331profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2332 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2333 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2334 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2335 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002336 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002337 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2338 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2339 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2340 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2341
2342 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2343 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2344 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2345 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2346 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002347 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2348 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2349 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2350 CLI.
2351
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002352spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002353 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2354 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2355 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2356 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2357 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2358 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002360ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002361 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002362 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002363 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2364 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2365 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2366 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2367 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002368 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2369 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002370 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2371 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2372 openssl configuration file uses:
2373 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2374
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002375ssl-mode-async
2376 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002377 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002378 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2379 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2380 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002381 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002382 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002383
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002384tune.buffers.limit <number>
2385 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2386 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2387 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2388 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2389 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002390 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002391 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2392 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2393 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2394 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2395 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2396 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2397 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2398 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2399 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2400
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002401tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2402 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2403 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2404 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2405 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2406
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002407tune.bufsize <number>
2408 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2409 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2410 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2411 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2412 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2413 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2414 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002415 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2416 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2417 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002418 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002419 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2420 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2421 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002422
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002423tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2424 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002425
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002426tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2427 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2428 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2429 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2430 this value. The default value is 1.
2431
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002432tune.fail-alloc
2433 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2434 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2435 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2436 gracefully.
2437
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002438tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2439 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2440 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2441 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2442 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2443 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2444
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002445tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2446 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2447 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2448 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2449 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2450 change it.
2451
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002452tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002454 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2455 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002456 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2457 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2458 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2459 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2460 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2461
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002462tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2463 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2464 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2465 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2466 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2467 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2468 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2469 recommended not to change this value.
2470
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002471tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2472 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2473 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2474 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2475 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2476 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2477 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2478 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2479
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002480tune.http.cookielen <number>
2481 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2482 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2483 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2484 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2485 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2486 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2487 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2488 to change this value.
2489
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002490tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002491 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2492 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002493 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002494 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002495 configuration directives too.
2496 The default value is 1024.
2497
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002498tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2499 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2500 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2501 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2502 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2503 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2504 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002505 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2506 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2507 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002508
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002509tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2510 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2511 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2512 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2513 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2514 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2515 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002516 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2517 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2518 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2519 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2520 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002521
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002522tune.idletimer <timeout>
2523 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2524 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2525 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2526 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2527 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2528 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002529 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002530 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2532
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002533tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2534 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2535 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2536 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2537 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2538 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2539 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2540 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2541 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2542 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2543
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002544tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2545 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002546 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002547 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2548 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002549 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002550 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2551 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2552
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002553tune.lua.maxmem
2554 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2555 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2556 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2557 memory.
2558
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002559tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2560 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002561 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2562 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002563 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002564
2565tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2566 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2567 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2568 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2569 check servers.
2570
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002571tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2572 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2573 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2574 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002575 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002576
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002577tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002578 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2579 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002580 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2581 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2582 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2583 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2584 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2585 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2586 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2587 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2588 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002589
2590tune.maxpollevents <number>
2591 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2592 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2593 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2594 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2595 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2596
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002597tune.maxrewrite <number>
2598 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2599 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2600 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2601 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2602 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2603 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2604 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2605 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2606 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2607 bufsize.
2608
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002609tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2610 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2611 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2612 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2613 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2614 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2615 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2616 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2617 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2618 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002619 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2620 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002621 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2622 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2623 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2624 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2625 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2626 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2627 setting this parameter to 0.
2628
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002629tune.pipesize <number>
2630 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2631 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2632 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2633 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2634 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2635 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2636
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002637tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2638 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2639 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2640 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2641 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2642 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2643 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002644 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002645
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002646tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2647 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2648 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2649 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2650 default is 20.
2651
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002652tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2653tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2654 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2655 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2656 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002657 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002658 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2660 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2661
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002662tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002663 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002664 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2665 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2666 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2667 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2668
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002669tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002670 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002671 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2672 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2673 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2674 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2675 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2676 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2677 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002678
2679tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2680 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2681 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2682 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2683 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2684 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2685 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2686 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2687 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2688 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002689
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002690tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2691tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2692 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2693 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2694 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002695 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002696 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2698 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2699 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2700 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2701 notifying haproxy again.
2702
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002703tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002704 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002705 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2706 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2707 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2708 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2709 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2710 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2711 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2712 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2713 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2714 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2715 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002716
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002717tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002718 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002719 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2720 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2721 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2722 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2723 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2724
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002725tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2726 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2727 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2728 performances. This is disabled by default.
2729
2730 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2731 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2732
2733 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2734
2735 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2736
2737 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2738
2739 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2740 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2741 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2742
2743 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2744 converted.
2745
2746 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2747 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2748 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2749 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2750 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2751 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2752 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002753 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2754 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002755
2756 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2757
2758 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2759 only need this line:
2760
2761 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2762
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002763tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2764 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002765 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002766 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2767 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2768 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2769 being used for too long.
2770
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002771tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2772 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2773 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2774 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2775 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2776 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2777 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2778 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2779 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2780 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2781 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002782 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002783 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002784
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002785tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2786 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2787 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2788 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2789 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002790 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002791 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2792 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002793 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2794 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002795
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002796tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2797 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2798 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2799 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2800 1000 entries.
2801
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002802tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2803 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2804 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2805 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2806
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002807tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002808tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002809tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2810tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2811tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002812 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2813 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2814 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2815 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2816 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2817 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2818 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2819 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002820
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002821 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2822 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2823 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2824 all available space is consumed.
2825 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2826 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2827 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002828
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002829tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2830 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002831 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002832 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002833 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002834 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2835
2836tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2837 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2838 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002839 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2840 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028423.3. Debugging
2843--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002845quiet
2846 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2847 line argument "-q".
2848
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002849zero-warning
2850 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2851 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2852 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2853 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2854 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2855 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028583.4. Userlists
2859--------------
2860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2863
2864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2867
2868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002891
2892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002893 userlist L1
2894 group G1 users tiger,scott
2895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2898 user scott insecure-password elgato
2899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002901 userlist L2
2902 group G1
2903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908
2909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002911
29123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002926
2927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2930
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002931bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2932 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2933 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2934
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002935disabled
2936 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2937 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2938 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940default-bind [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2942
2943default-server [param*]
2944 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2945
2946 Arguments:
2947 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2948 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2949 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2950 details.
2951
2952
2953 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2954
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002955enable
2956 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2957
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002958log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002959 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2960 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2961 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2962 more details.
2963
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002964peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002965 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2966 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002967 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2968 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2969 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2970 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2971 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002972
2973 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2974 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2975
2976 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002977 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2978 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2979 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002980
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2982 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002983
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002984 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2985 "server" keyword explanation below).
2986
2987server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002988 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002989 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2990 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2991 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2992 of this "peers" section).
2993 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2994
2995
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002996 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002997 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002998 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002999 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3000 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3001 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003002
3003 backend mybackend
3004 mode tcp
3005 balance roundrobin
3006 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3007 stick on src
3008
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003009 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3010 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003012 Example:
3013 peers mypeers
3014 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3015 default-server ssl verify none
3016 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3017 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003018
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003019
3020table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3021 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3022
3023 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3024 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003025 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003026 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3027 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3028 "stick-table" keyword).
3029
3030 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3031 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3032 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3033 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3034 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3035 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3036 of the stick-table name as follows:
3037
3038 peers mypeers
3039 peer A ...
3040 peer B ...
3041 table t1 ...
3042
3043 frontend fe1
3044 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3045
3046 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3047 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3048
3049 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3050 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3051 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3052 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3053 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3054 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3055 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3056
3057 peers mypeers
3058 peer A ...
3059 peer B ...
3060 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3061
3062 backend t1
3063 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3064
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003065 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003066 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3067 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3068
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030693.6. Mailers
3070------------
3071It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3072If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3073in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3074
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003075mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003076 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3077 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3078
3079mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3080 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3081
3082 Example:
3083 mailers mymailers
3084 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3085 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3086
3087 backend mybackend
3088 mode tcp
3089 balance roundrobin
3090
3091 email-alert mailers mymailers
3092 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3093 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3094
3095 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3096 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3097
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003098timeout mail <time>
3099 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3100 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3101 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3102 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3103
3104 Example:
3105 mailers mymailers
3106 timeout mail 20s
3107 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003108
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031093.7. Programs
3110-------------
3111In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3112master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3113managed the same way as the workers.
3114
3115During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3116sequence as a worker:
3117
3118 - the master is re-executed
3119 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3120 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3121 instance of the program
3122
3123During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3124
3125program <name>
3126 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3127 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3128 the management guide).
3129
3130command <command> [arguments*]
3131 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3132 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3133 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3134 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3135
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003136user <user name>
3137 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3138 See also "group".
3139
3140group <group name>
3141 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3142 See also "user".
3143
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003144option start-on-reload
3145no option start-on-reload
3146 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3147 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3148 program section.
3149
3150
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031513.8. HTTP-errors
3152----------------
3153
3154It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3155imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3156several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3157
3158http-errors <name>
3159 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3160 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3161
3162errorfile <code> <file>
3163 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3164
3165 Arguments :
3166 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003167 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003168 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003169
3170 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3171 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3172 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3173 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3174 before any chroot is performed.
3175
3176 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3177
3178 Example:
3179 http-errors website-1
3180 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3181 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3182 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3183
3184 http-errors website-2
3185 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3186 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3187 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3188
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031893.9. Rings
3190----------
3191
3192It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3193servers or traces.
3194
3195ring <ringname>
3196 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3197
3198description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003199 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003200 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3201
3202format <format>
3203 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3204
3205 Arguments:
3206 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3207 one of the following :
3208
3209 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3210 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3211 designed to be used with a local log server.
3212
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003213 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3214 field is stripped. This is the default.
3215 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3216 rfc3164.
3217
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003218 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3219 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3220 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3221 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3222 is the default.
3223
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003224 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003225 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3226
3227 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3228 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3229
3230 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3231 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3232 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3233 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3234 logger consumes.
3235
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003236 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3237 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3238 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3239 with a local log server.
3240
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003241 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3242 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3243 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3244 used with a local log server.
3245
3246maxlen <length>
3247 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3248 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3249 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3250
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003251server <name> <address> [param*]
3252 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3253 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3254 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3255 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3256 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3257 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3258 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3259 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3260 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003261 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3262 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003263
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003264size <size>
3265 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3266 set to BUFSIZE.
3267
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003268timeout connect <timeout>
3269 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3270
3271 Arguments :
3272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3274 as explained at the top of this document.
3275
3276timeout server <timeout>
3277 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3278
3279 Arguments :
3280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3282 as explained at the top of this document.
3283
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003284 Example:
3285 global
3286 log ring@myring local7
3287
3288 ring myring
3289 description "My local buffer"
3290 format rfc3164
3291 maxlen 1200
3292 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003293 timeout connect 5s
3294 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003295 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003296
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032973.10. Log forwarding
3298-------------------
3299
3300It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3301haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3302
3303log-forward <name>
3304 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3305
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003306backlog <conns>
3307 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3308 on connections accept.
3309
3310bind <addr> [param*]
3311 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003312 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3313 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3314 syslog protocol over TCP.
3315 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003316 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3317
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003318dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003319 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3320 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3321 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3322 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003323 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003324
3325log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003326log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003327 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3328 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3329 documentation.
3330 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3331 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3332 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3333 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3334 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3335
3336 Example:
3337 global
3338 log stderr format iso local7
3339
3340 ring myring
3341 description "My local buffer"
3342 format rfc5424
3343 maxlen 1200
3344 size 32764
3345 timeout connect 5s
3346 timeout server 10s
3347 # syslog tcp server
3348 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3349
3350 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003351 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3352 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003353 # all messages on stderr
3354 log global
3355 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3356 log ring@myring local0
3357 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3358 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3359 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3360 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3361 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003362
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003363maxconn <conns>
3364 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3365 10 is the default.
3366
3367timeout client <timeout>
3368 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033704. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003371----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003373Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003374 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3375 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3376 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3377 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003378
3379A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3380connections.
3381
3382A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3383to forward incoming connections.
3384
3385A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3386parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3387
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003388A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3389ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3390sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3391the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3392explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3393from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3394"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3395for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3396to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3397optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3398are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3399any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3400names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3401that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3402duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3403names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3404
3405Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3406settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3407of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3408profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3409timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3412'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3413case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3414
3415Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3416logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3417proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3418However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3419name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3420
3421Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3422and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003423bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3425modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3426arbitrary criteria.
3427
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003428In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3429a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003430the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003431
3432 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3433 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3434 between responses and new requests.
3435
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003436 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3437 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3438 client-facing connection remains open.
3439
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003440 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3441 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003442
3443The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3444frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3445following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003446weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003447
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003448 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003449
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003450 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3451 ----+-----+-----+----
3452 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3453 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003454 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3455 ----+-----+-----+----
3456 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003457
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003458It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3459only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3460into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3461as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3462content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3463and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3464possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003466There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3467first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3468processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3469second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3470protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3471is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3472new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3473to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3474process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3475already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3476HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3477evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3478one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3479
3480There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3481performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3482tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3483preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3484analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3485HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3486header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3487mitigate this drawback.
3488
3489It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3490method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3491set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3492in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3493is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3494to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3495above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3496to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3497"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3498frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3499frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3500as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3501upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3502on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3503the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3504upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3505frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3506remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3509--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003511The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3512limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3513they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3514limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003516option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003517and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3518with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3519specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003522 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3523------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3524acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003525backlog X X X -
3526balance X - X X
3527bind - X X -
3528bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529capture cookie - X X -
3530capture request header - X X -
3531capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003532clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3533clitcpka-idle X X X -
3534clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003535compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003537declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538default-server X - X X
3539default_backend X X X -
3540description - X X X
3541disabled X X X X
3542dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003543email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003544email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003545email-alert mailers X X X X
3546email-alert myhostname X X X X
3547email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003548enabled X X X X
3549errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003550errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003551errorloc X X X X
3552errorloc302 X X X X
3553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3554errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003555force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003556filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557fullconn X - X X
3558grace X X X X
3559hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003560http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003561http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003562http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003564http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003565http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003566http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003567http-check set-var X - X X
3568http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003569http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003571http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003572http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003573http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003575ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003576load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003577log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003578log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003579log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003580log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003581max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582maxconn X X X -
3583mode X X X X
3584monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585monitor-uri X X X -
3586option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3587option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3588option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3589option allbackups (*) X - X X
3590option checkcache (*) X - X X
3591option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3592option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003593option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3595option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3597option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003598option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003600option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003601option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003602option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003603option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003604option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3606option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3607option httpchk X - X X
3608option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003609option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003610option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003611option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003612option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003613option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3615option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3616option logasap (*) X X X -
3617option mysql-check X - X X
3618option nolinger (*) X X X X
3619option originalto X X X X
3620option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003621option pgsql-check X - X X
3622option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003624option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003625option smtpchk X - X X
3626option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3627option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3628option splice-request (*) X X X X
3629option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003630option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3632option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003634option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003635option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3636option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3637option tcpka X X X X
3638option tcplog X X X X
3639option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003640external-check command X - X X
3641external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3643rate-limit sessions X X X -
3644redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003647retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003649server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003650server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003652srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3653srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3654srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003655stats admin - X X X
3656stats auth X X X X
3657stats enable X X X X
3658stats hide-version X X X X
3659stats http-request - X X X
3660stats realm X X X X
3661stats refresh X X X X
3662stats scope X X X X
3663stats show-desc X X X X
3664stats show-legends X X X X
3665stats show-node X X X X
3666stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3668stick match - - X X
3669stick on - - X X
3670stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003671stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003672stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003673tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003674tcp-check connect X - X X
3675tcp-check expect X - X X
3676tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003677tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003678tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003679tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003680tcp-check set-var X - X X
3681tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003682tcp-request connection - X X -
3683tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003684tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003685tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003686tcp-response content - - X X
3687tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003688timeout check X - X X
3689timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003690timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3693timeout http-request X X X X
3694timeout queue X - X X
3695timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003696timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003698timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003700unique-id-format X X X -
3701unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003703use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003704use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3706 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037094.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3710---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003711
3712This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3713
3714
3715acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3716 Declare or complete an access list.
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 no | yes | yes | yes
3719 Example:
3720 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3721 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3722 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003724 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725
3726
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003727backlog <conns>
3728 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | no
3731 Arguments :
3732 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3733 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003734 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003735
3736 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3737 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3738 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3739 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3740 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3741 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3742 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3743 backlog parameter.
3744
3745 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3746 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3747 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3748
3749 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3750
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003753balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | no | yes | yes
3757 Arguments :
3758 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3759 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3760 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3761 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3762
3763 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3764 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3765 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3766 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003767 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003768 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003769 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3770 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3771 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3772 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3773 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3774 it, so that you don't worry.
3775
3776 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3777 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3778 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3779 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3780 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3781 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3782 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3783 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003785 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3786 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3787 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3788 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3789 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3790 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3791 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003792 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3793 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3794 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003795
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003796 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003797 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003798 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3799 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003800 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003801 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3802 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3803 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3804 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3805 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003806 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3807 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3808 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3809 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3810 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3811 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3814 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3815 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3816 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3817 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3818 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3819 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3820 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003821 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003823 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3824 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3825 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003826
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003827 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3828 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3829 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3830 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3831 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3832 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3833 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3834 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3835 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3836 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3837 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3838 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003840 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003841 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3842 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3843 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3844 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3845 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3846 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3847 URIs start with a leading "/".
3848
3849 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3850 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3851 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3852 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3853
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003854 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3855 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3856 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3857 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003860 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3861
3862 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003863 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3864 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003865 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3866 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3867 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3868 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003869 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003870 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3871 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003872
3873 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3874 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3875 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3876 server will receive the request.
3877
3878 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3879 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3880 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3881 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3882 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003883 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3884 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3885 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003886
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003887 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3888 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3889 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3890 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3891 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003893 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003894 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3895 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3896 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3897
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003898 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3899 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3900 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3901
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003902 random
3903 random(<draws>)
3904 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003905 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3906 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3907 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3908 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003909 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3910 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3911 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3912 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3913 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3914 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3915 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3916 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3917 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3918 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3919 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3920 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3921 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3922 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3923 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3924 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3925 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3926 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3927 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3928 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003929
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003930 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003931 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003932 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3933 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3934 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3935 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3936 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3937 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003938 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 used instead.
3940
3941 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3942 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3943 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3944 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3945
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003946 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3947 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3948 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3949
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003950 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003953 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3954 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003955
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003956 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3957 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3958 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003960 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003961 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003962 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3963 NTLM relies on.
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965 Examples :
3966 balance roundrobin
3967 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003968 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003969 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3970 balance hdr(host)
3971 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972
3973 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3974 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3978 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3979 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003980 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3983 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3984 defaults to 16 kB.
3985
3986 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3987 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3988
3989 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3990 Round Robin.
3991
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003992 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003993 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3994 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3995 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3996
3997 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3998
3999 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004000 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004001 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4002 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4003 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004005 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
4007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004008bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4009bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 no | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004014 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4015 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4016 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4017 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004018 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004019 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4020 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4021 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4022 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4023 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4024 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004025 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004026 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4027 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004028 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004029 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4030 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004031 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004032 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4033 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004034 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004035 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4036 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4037 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4038 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4039 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4040 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4041 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004042 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4043 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4044 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004045 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4046 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4047 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4048 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004049 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4050 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4051 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004052
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004053 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4054 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004055 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4056 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4057 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004058 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4059 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4060 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4061 the range.
4062
4063 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4064 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4065 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4066 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4067 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4068 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4069 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004070 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004071 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004073 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004074 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004075 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4076 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4077 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4078 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4079 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4080 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004082 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4083 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4084 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4085 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4088 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4089 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4090 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4091 in a frontend.
4092
4093 Example :
4094 listen http_proxy
4095 bind :80,:443
4096 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004097 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004098
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004099 listen http_https_proxy
4100 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004101 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004103 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4104 bind ipv6@:80
4105 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4106 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4107
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004108 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004109 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004110
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004111 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4112 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4113 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4114 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4115 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4116
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004117 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004118 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004119
4120
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004121bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004122 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | yes | yes | yes
4125 Arguments :
4126 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4127 may be used to override a default value.
4128
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004129 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004130 option may be combined with other numbers.
4131
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004132 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004133 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4134 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4135 missing from all processes.
4136
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004137 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004138 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004139 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4140 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4141 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4142 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4143 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004144 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004145
4146 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4147 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4148 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4149 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4150 and 'even' instances.
4151
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004152 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4153 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4154 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4155 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004156
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004157 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4158 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4159
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004160 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4161 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4162 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4163
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004164 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4165 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4166
4167 Example :
4168 listen app_ip1
4169 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004170 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004171
4172 listen app_ip2
4173 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004174 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004175
4176 listen management
4177 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004178 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004179
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004180 listen management
4181 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4182 bind-process 1-4
4183
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004184 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004185
4186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004187capture cookie <name> len <length>
4188 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4190 no | yes | yes | no
4191 Arguments :
4192 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4193 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4194 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4195 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004196 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004197
4198 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4199 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4200 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4201 right if it exceeds <length>.
4202
4203 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4204 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4205 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4206 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4207
4208 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4209 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4210 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4211
4212 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4213 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4214 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004215 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4216 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4217 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004218
4219 Example:
4220 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4221
4222 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004223 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
4225
4226capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004227 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4229 no | yes | yes | no
4230 Arguments :
4231 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004232 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004233 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4234 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4235 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4236
4237 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4238 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4239 it exceeds <length>.
4240
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004241 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4243 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004244 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4245 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4246 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4247 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004248 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004249 environments to find where the request came from.
4250
4251 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4252 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4253 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4254 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004256 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4257 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4258 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4259 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4260 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261
4262 Example:
4263 capture request header Host len 15
4264 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004265 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004267 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268 about logging.
4269
4270
4271capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004272 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 no | yes | yes | no
4275 Arguments :
4276 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004277 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4279 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4280 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4281
4282 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4283 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4284 it exceeds <length>.
4285
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004286 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4288 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4289 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004290 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4291 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4292 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4293 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004295 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4296 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4297 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4298 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4299 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004300
4301 Example:
4302 capture response header Content-length len 9
4303 capture response header Location len 15
4304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004305 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 about logging.
4307
4308
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004309clitcpka-cnt <count>
4310 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4311 the connection on the client side.
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | yes | yes | no
4314 Arguments :
4315 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4316
4317 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4318 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004319 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4320 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004321
4322 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4323
4324
4325clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4326 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4327 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4328 client side.
4329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4330 yes | yes | yes | no
4331 Arguments :
4332 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4333 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4334 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4335 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4336
4337 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4338 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004339 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4340 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004341
4342 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4343
4344
4345clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4346 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4348 yes | yes | yes | no
4349 Arguments :
4350 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4351 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4352 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4353 document.
4354
4355 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4356 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004357 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4358 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004359
4360 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4361
4362
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004363compression algo <algorithm> ...
4364compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004365compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004366 Enable HTTP compression.
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | yes | yes | yes
4369 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004370 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4371 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4372 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4373
4374 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004375 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4376 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4377 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004378
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004379 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004380 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004381
4382 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4383 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4384 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4385 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4386 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004387 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004388
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004389 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4390 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4391 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4392 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4393 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4394 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4395 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004396 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004397
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004398 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004399 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004400 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4401 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4402 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4403 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4404 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004405
4406 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4407 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4408 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4409 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4410 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004411 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4412 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4413 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4414 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4415 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004416 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4417 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004418
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004419 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004420 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4421 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004422 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004423 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004424 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4425 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4426 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4427 "multipart"
4428 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4429 header
4430 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4431 and later
4432 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4433 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004434 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004435
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004436 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004437
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004438 Examples :
4439 compression algo gzip
4440 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004441
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004442
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004443cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004444 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4445 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004446 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004447 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | no | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
4451 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4452 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4453 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4454 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4455 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4456 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004457 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4459 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4460
4461 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4462 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4463 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4464 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4465 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4466 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004467 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4468 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004469 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004470 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4471 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
4473 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004474 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004475
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004476 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004477 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004478 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004479 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004480 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4481 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4482 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4483 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4484 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4485 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4486 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004487
4488 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4489 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4490 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4491 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4492 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4493 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4494 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4495 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4496 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004497 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004498 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4499 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4500 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004502 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4503 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4504 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004505 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4506 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4507 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4508 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004509 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4510 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4511 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512
4513 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4514 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4515 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4516 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4517 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4518 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4519 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4520 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4521 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4522
4523 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4524 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4525 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4526 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4527 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4528 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4529 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4530 persistence cookie in the cache.
4531 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4532
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004533 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4534 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4535 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4536 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4537 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004538 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004539 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4540 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4541 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4542 they logout.
4543
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004544 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4545 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4546 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4547 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4548
4549 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4550 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4551 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4552 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4553 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4554 this attribute.
4555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004556 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004557 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004558 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4559 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4560 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4561 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4562 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4563 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004564
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004565 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4566 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4567 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4568 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4569 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4570 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4571 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4572 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004573 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004574 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4575 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4576 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4577 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4578 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4579 the site.
4580
4581 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4582 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4583 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4584 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4585 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4586 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4587 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4588 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4589 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4590 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4591 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4592 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4593 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004594 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004595 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4596 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4597
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004598 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4599 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4600 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4601 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4602 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4603 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4604
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004605 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4606 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4607 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4608 repeated.
4609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004610 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4611 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4612 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4613 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615 Examples :
4616 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4617 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4618 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004621 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004622
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004623
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004624declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4625 Declares a capture slot.
4626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4627 no | yes | yes | no
4628 Arguments:
4629 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4630
4631 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4632 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4633 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4634 for use in the response.
4635
4636 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004637 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004638 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4639
4640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004641default-server [param*]
4642 Change default options for a server in a backend
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | no | yes | yes
4645 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004646 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4647 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4648 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4649 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004650
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004651 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004652 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4653
4654 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004657default_backend <backend>
4658 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4660 yes | yes | yes | no
4661 Arguments :
4662 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4663
4664 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4665 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4666 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4667 will catch all undetermined requests.
4668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Example :
4670
4671 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4672 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4673 default_backend dynamic
4674
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004675 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004677
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004678description <string>
4679 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | yes
4682 Arguments : string
4683
4684 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4685 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4686 it describes.
4687 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4688
4689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690disabled
4691 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | yes | yes | yes
4694 Arguments : none
4695
4696 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4697 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4698 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4699 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4700 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4701 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4702 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4703
4704 See also : "enabled"
4705
4706
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004707dispatch <address>:<port>
4708 Set a default server address
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004712
4713 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4714 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4715 during start-up.
4716
4717 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4718 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4719 possible with normal servers.
4720
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004721 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004722 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4723 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4724 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4725 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4726
4727 See also : "server"
4728
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004729
4730dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4731 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 yes | no | yes | yes
4734 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4735
4736 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004737 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004738 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4739 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004740 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004741 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004743enabled
4744 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | yes
4747 Arguments : none
4748
4749 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4750 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4751
4752 See also : "disabled"
4753
4754
4755errorfile <code> <file>
4756 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | yes
4759 Arguments :
4760 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004761 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004762 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004763
4764 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004765 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004766 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004767 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4768 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004769
4770 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4771 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4772 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4773
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004774 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4775
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004776 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4777 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4778 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4779 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4780 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4781 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4782 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4783 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4784 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004786 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4787 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4788 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004789 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004790 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4791
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004792 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004793
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004794 Example :
4795 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004796 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004797 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4798 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4799
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004800
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004801errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4802 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4803 section.
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments :
4807 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4808
4809 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004810 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004811 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4812 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004813
4814 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4815 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4816 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4817 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4818 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004819 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004820 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4821
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004822 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4823 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004824
4825 Example :
4826 errorfiles generic
4827 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4828
4829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830errorloc <code> <url>
4831errorloc302 <code> <url>
4832 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835 Arguments :
4836 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004837 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004838 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004839
4840 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4841 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4842 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4843 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004844 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004845
4846 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4847 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4848 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004850 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4853 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4854 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4855 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004856 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004857 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4858 request.
4859
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004860 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004861
4862
4863errorloc303 <code> <url>
4864 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867 Arguments :
4868 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004869 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004870 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871
4872 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4873 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4874 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4875 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004876 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004877
4878 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4879 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4880 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4881
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004882 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4885 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4886 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4887 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004888 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004889
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004890 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004891
4892
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004893email-alert from <emailaddr>
4894 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004895 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900
4901 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4902
4903 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4904 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4905
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004906 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004907 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4908 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004909
4910
4911email-alert level <level>
4912 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4913 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916
4917 Arguments :
4918
4919 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4920 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4921 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4922
4923 By default level is alert
4924
4925 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4926 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4927 for the proxy.
4928
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004929 Alerts are sent when :
4930
4931 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4932 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4933 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4934 is notice or lower
4935 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4936 and a health check status update occurs
4937
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004938 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4939 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004940 section 3.6 about mailers.
4941
4942
4943email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4944 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949
4950 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4951
4952 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4953 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4956 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004957
4958
4959email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4960 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4961 mailers.
4962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | yes
4964
4965 Arguments :
4966
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004967 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004968
4969 By default the systems hostname is used.
4970
4971 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4972 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4973 for the proxy.
4974
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004975 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4976 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004977
4978
4979email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004980 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004981 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
4984
4985 Arguments :
4986
4987 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4988
4989 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4990 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004993 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4994
4995
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004996force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4997 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004999 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005000
5001 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5002 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5003 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5004 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5005 marked down for maintenance operations.
5006
5007 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5008 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5009 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5010 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5011 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5012 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5013 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5014 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5015 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5016
5017 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5018 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5019 is used.
5020
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005021 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005022 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005023
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005024
5025filter <name> [param*]
5026 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5028 no | yes | yes | yes
5029 Arguments :
5030 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5031 referenced in section 9.
5032
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005033 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005034 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005035 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5036 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005037
5038 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5039 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5040
5041 Example:
5042 listen
5043 bind *:80
5044
5045 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5046 filter compression
5047 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5048
5049 compression algo gzip
5050 compression offload
5051
5052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5053
5054 See also : section 9.
5055
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005056
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057fullconn <conns>
5058 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 yes | no | yes | yes
5061 Arguments :
5062 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5063 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5064
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005065 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005066 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005067 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5069 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5070 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5071 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5072 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005074
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005075 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5076 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005077 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5078 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5079 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081 Example :
5082 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5083 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5084 # connections.
5085 backend dynamic
5086 fullconn 10000
5087 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5088 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5089
5090 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5091
5092
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005093grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005096 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005097 Arguments :
5098 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5099 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5100 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5101
5102 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5103 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005104 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005105 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5106
5107 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5108 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5109 simplify it.
5110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005111
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005112hash-balance-factor <factor>
5113 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | no | no | yes
5116 Arguments :
5117 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5118 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005119 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005120
5121 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5122 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5123 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5124 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5125 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5126 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5127 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5128
5129 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5130 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5131 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5132 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5133 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5134
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005135 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5136 consistent hashing mechanism.
5137
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005138 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5139
5140
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005141hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005142 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5144 yes | no | yes | yes
5145 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005146 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5147 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005148
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005149 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5150 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5151 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5152 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5153 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5154 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5155 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5156 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5157 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5158 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005159
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005160 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5161 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5162 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5163 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5164 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5165 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5166 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5167 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5168 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5169 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5170 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5171 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5172 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005173 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5174 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005175
5176 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5177
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005178 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005179 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5180 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5181 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005182 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5183 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5184 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005185
5186 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5187 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005188 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5189 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5190 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5191 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5192
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005193 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5194 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5195 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5196 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5197 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5198 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5199 parameter.
5200
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005201 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5202 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5203 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5204 used on strings.
5205
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005206 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5207
5208 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5209 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5210 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5211 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5212 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5213 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5214 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5215 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5216 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5217 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5218 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5219 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005220
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005221 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5222 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5223 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005224
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005225 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005226
5227
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005228http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5229 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5230 ones).
5231
5232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5233 no | yes | yes | yes
5234
5235 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5236 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5237 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5238 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5239 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5240 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5241
5242 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5243 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5244 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5245
5246 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5247 below.
5248
5249 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5250 instance.
5251
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005252 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5253 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5254 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5255
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005256 Example:
5257 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5258 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5259 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5260
5261http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5264 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5265 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5266 example, or to pass some internal information.
5267 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5268 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5269 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5270
5271http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272
5273 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5274 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5275
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005276http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005277
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005278 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5279 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5280 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5281 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5282 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005283
5284http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5286
5287 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5288
5289 Example:
5290 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5291
5292 # applied to:
5293 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5294
5295 # outputs:
5296 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5297
5298 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5299
5300http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5302
5303 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5304
5305 Example:
5306 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5307
5308 # applied to:
5309 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5310
5311 # outputs:
5312 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5313
5314http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5317 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5318 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5319
5320http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322
5323 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5324 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5325 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5326 fallback.
5327
5328 Example:
5329 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5330 http-response set-status 431
5331 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5332 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5333
5334http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5335
5336 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5337 inline.
5338
5339 Arguments:
5340 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5341 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5345 (request and response)
5346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5347 processing
5348 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5349 processing
5350 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5351 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5352 and '_'.
5353
5354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5355 followed by some converters.
5356
5357 Example:
5358 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5359
5360http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5361
5362 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5363 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5364 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5365 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5366 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005367 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005368 processing.
5369
5370 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5371 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005372 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005373 rules evaluation.
5374
5375http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5378 details about <var-name>.
5379
5380 Example:
5381 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5382
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005383
5384http-check comment <string>
5385 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5386 it fails.
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | no | yes | yes
5389
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005390 Arguments :
5391 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5392 rule fails.
5393
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005394 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5395 user-friendly error reporting.
5396
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005397 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005398 "http-check expect".
5399
5400
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005401http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5402 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005403 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | yes | yes
5407
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005408 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005409 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5410
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005411 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005412 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005413
5414 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5415 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5416 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5417 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5418
5419 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5420
5421 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5422
5423 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5424
5425 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5426
5427 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5428
5429 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5430 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5431 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5432 is used.
5433
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005434 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5435 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5436 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5437 haproxy -vv.
5438
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005439 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5440
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005441 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5442 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5443 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5444 different ports or with different servers.
5445
5446 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5447 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5448 the port with a "http-check connect".
5449
5450 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5451 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5452 do.
5453
5454 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5455 unset-var or comment rules.
5456
5457 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5459 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5460 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5461 option httpchk
5462
5463 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005464 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005465 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005467 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005468 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469
5470 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5471
5472 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005475http-check disable-on-404
5476 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005479 Arguments : none
5480
5481 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5482 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5483 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5484 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5485 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5486 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5487 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5488 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005489 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5490 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005491 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5492 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5493 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005496
5497
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005498http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005499 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5500 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5501 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005502 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005504 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005505
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005506 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005507 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5508
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5510 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5511 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5512 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5513 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5514 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5515 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5516 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5517 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5518 result is always conclusive.
5519
5520 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5521 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5522 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005523 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5524 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005525 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5526 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005527 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5528 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5529 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005530
5531 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5532 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005533 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5534 supported :
5535 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5536 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005537 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5538 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5539 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5540 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5541 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005542
5543 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5544 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005545 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5546 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5547 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5548 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005549 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5550
5551 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5552 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5553 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5554 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5555
5556 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5557 informational message reported in logs if an error
5558 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5559 log-format string.
5560
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005561 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005562 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5563 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005564 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5565 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5566 details on the supported keywords.
5567
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005568 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5569 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5570 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5571 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005572
5573 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5574 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5575 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5576 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5577 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5578
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005579 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5580 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5581 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5582 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5583 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5584 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5585 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005586
5587 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005589 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5590 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5591 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5592 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5593
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005594 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5595 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005596 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5597 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5598 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5599 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5600 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5601 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5602 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5603 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005604 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5605 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5606 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5607 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5608 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5609 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5610 insensitive on the header names.
5611
5612 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5613 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5614 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5615 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5616 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5617 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005618
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005619 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005620 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5622 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5623 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5624 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5625 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005626 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005627 trace).
5628
5629 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005631 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5632 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5633 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5634 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5635 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005636 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005638 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5639 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5640 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5641 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5642 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5643 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5644
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005646 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005647 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5648 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5649 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5650 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5651 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5652 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5653
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5655 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5656 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5657 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5658 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005659
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005660 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5661 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5662
5663 Examples :
5664 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005665 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005667 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5668 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5669
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005671 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005672
5673 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005674 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675
5676 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005677 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005678
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005679 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005680 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005681
5682
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005683http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005684 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5685 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005686 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5687 health checks.
5688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5689 yes | no | yes | yes
5690 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005691 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5692
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005693 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5694 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5695 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5696 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5697 to invent non-standard ones.
5698
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005699 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5700 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5701 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5702 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5703
5704 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5705 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5706 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5707 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005708
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005709 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005710 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005711 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5713 to add it.
5714
5715 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5716 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5717 to the log-format rules.
5718
5719 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5720 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5721 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005722
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005723 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5724 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5725 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5726 request.
5727
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005728 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5729 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5730 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005731 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5732 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5733 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5734 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005735 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005736
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005737 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005738 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5739 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005740
5741 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5742 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5743 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5744 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5745 configured request authority.
5746
5747 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5748 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005750 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005751
5752
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005753http-check send-state
5754 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments : none
5758
5759 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5760 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5761 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5762 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5763 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5764
5765 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5766 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5767 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5768 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5769 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005770 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5771 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5772 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5773
5774 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5775 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5776 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5777
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005778 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5779 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5780 checked in multiple backends.
5781
5782 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5783 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5784
5785 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5786 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5787 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5788 one fails.
5789
5790 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5791 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5792 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5793
5794 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5795 server's queue.
5796
5797 Example of a header received by the application server :
5798 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5799 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005801 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5802 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005803
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005804
5805http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005806 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | no | yes | yes
5809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005810 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005811 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5812 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5813 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5815 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5817 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5818 and '-'.
5819
5820 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5821
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005822 Examples :
5823 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005824
5825
5826http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005827 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005831 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005832 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5833 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5836 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5838 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5839 and '-'.
5840
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005841 Examples :
5842 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005843
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005844
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005845http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5846 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5847 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5848 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5849 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | yes | yes | yes
5852 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005853 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005854 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005855 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005856 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005857
5858 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5859 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5860 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5861 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5862
5863 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5864 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5865 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5866 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5867
5868 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5869 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5870 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5871 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5872 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5873 chroot is performed.
5874
5875 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5876 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5877 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5878 considered.
5879
5880 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5881 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5882 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5883 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5884 considered as a raw string.
5885
5886 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5887 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5888 "content-type".
5889
5890 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5891 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5892 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5893 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5894 evaluated as a log-format string.
5895
5896 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5897 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5898 argument to "content-type".
5899
5900 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5901 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5902 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5903 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5904
5905 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5906 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5907 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5908 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5909 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5910 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5911 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5912 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5913
5914 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5915 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5916 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5917
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005918 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5919 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5920 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5921 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5922 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5923
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005924 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5925 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5926
5927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005929 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5930
5931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 no | yes | yes | yes
5933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005934 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5935 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5936 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5937 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5938 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5941 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945 Example:
5946 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5947 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5948 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950 http-request allow if nagios
5951 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5952 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5953 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 Example:
5956 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5957 acl add path /addacl
5958 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5963 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 Example:
5966 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5967 acl setmap path /setmap
5968 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005972 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5973 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5976 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5981 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5982 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5983 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5984 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5985 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5986 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5987 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005991 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5992 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5993 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5994 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5995 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5996 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5997 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5998 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005999
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006000http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6003 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006004
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006006http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6009 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6010 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6011 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6012 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006013
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006014 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6015 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6016 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6017 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6018 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6019 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6020 instead.
6021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 Example:
6023 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6024 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006026http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006027
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006028 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6031 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6034 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6035 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6036 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6037 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6038 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6039 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6040 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6041 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6044 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6045 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006046 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6047
6048 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6049 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6050 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6051 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6056 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6057 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6058 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6059 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6060 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006061
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006062http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006063
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006064 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6065 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6066 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6067 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6068 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6073 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6074 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6075 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6076 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6077 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006078
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006079http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6081 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6082 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6083 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006085
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006086 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6087 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6088 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006089 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006090 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6091 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6092 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006094 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006095
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006096http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6097 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6098 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6099 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6100
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006101http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6102
6103 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6104 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6105 pointed by <resolvers>.
6106 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6107 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6108 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6109 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6110 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6111 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6112 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6113 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6114 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6115 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6116 to 0.0.0.0.
6117
6118 Example:
6119 resolvers mydns
6120 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6121 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6122 timeout retry 1s
6123 hold valid 10s
6124 hold nx 3s
6125 hold other 3s
6126 hold obsolete 0s
6127 accepted_payload_size 8192
6128
6129 frontend fe
6130 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6131 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6132 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6133
6134 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6135 # which mean DNS resolution error
6136 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6137
6138 default_backend be
6139
6140 backend b_503
6141 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6142 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6143 # 503 error page to end users
6144
6145 backend be
6146 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6147 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6148 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6149 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6150 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6151
6152 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6153 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6154
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006155http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156
6157 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6158 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6159 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6160 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006161 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6162 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006163
6164 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6165
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006166http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006167http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006168http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006169http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006170http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006171http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6172http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006173
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006174 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6175
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006176 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006177 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6178 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6179 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6180 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006181
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006182 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6183 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6184 the supported backend.
6185
6186 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6187 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6188 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6189 number of segments in the path.
6190
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006191 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6192 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6193 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6194 when improperly combined.
6195
6196 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6197 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6198 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6199 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6200 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6201
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006202 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006203
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006204 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6205 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006206
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006207 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6208 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6209
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006210 Example:
6211 - /. -> /
6212 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6213 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6214 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006215
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006216 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6217 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6218
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006219 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006220 their preceding segment.
6221
6222 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6223 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6224
6225 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6226 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006227
6228 Example:
6229 - /foo/../ -> /
6230 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6231 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6232 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006233 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006234 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006235 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006236
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006237 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6238 removed as well:
6239
6240 Example:
6241 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6242 - /bar/../../ -> /
6243
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006244 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6245 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006246
6247 Example:
6248 - // -> /
6249 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6250
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006251 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6252 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6253
6254 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6255 ".", "_", and "~".
6256
6257 Example:
6258 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6259 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6260 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6261 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6262
6263 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6264 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6265
6266 Example:
6267 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6268 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6269
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006270 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006271 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006272
6273 Example:
6274 - /%6f -> /%6F
6275 - /%zz -> /%zz
6276
6277 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6278 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6279
6280 Example:
6281 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6282
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006283 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006284 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6285 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6286
6287 Example:
6288 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6289 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6290 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006292http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006294 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6295 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6296 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6297 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6298 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006300http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006302 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6303 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6304 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6305 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006307http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6308 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006309
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006310 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006311 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6312 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6313 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6314 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6315 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006316
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006317 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6318 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6319 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6320 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6321 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006322
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006323 Example:
6324 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6325
6326 # applied to:
6327 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6328
6329 # outputs:
6330 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6331
6332 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006333
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006334 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6335
6336 # applied to:
6337 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006338
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006339 # outputs:
6340 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006341
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006342http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6343 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6344
6345 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6346 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006347 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6348 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6349 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006350
6351 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6352 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6353 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6354
6355 Example:
6356 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6357 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6358
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006359 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6360 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6361 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6362 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6363
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006364http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6366
6367 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6368 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6369 query-string are replaced.
6370
6371 Example:
6372 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6373 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6374
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006375http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6377
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006378 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6379 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6380 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6381 against.
6382
6383 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6384 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6385 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006386
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006387 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6388 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6389 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6390 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6391 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6392 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6393 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6394 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6395 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006396 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6397 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006398
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006399 Example:
6400 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6401 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006402
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006403 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6404 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006406http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006408
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006409 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6410 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6411 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6412 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 Example:
6415 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006416
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006417 # applied to:
6418 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006419
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006420 # outputs:
6421 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006422
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006423http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6424 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6425 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006426 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6428
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006429 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006430 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6431 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006432 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006433 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006434 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006435 are followed to create the response :
6436
6437 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6438 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6439 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6440 ignored.
6441
6442 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6443 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006444 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006445 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6446 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006447
6448 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6449 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6450 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006451 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6452 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006453
6454 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6455 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6456 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006457 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006458 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006459 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006460
6461 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6462 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6463 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6464 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6465 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6466 as a raw content.
6467
6468 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6469 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6470 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6471 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6472 considered as a raw string.
6473
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006474 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006475 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6476 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6477 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6478
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006479 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6480 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006481 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006482
6483 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6484
6485 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006486 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006487 if { path /ping }
6488
6489 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6490 if { path /favicon.ico }
6491
6492 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6493 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6494 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6497http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006499 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6500 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6501 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006502
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006503http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006505
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006506 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6507 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6508 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6509 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006511http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6514 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6515 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6516 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6517 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006519 Arguments:
6520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6521 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006523 Example:
6524 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6525 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006527 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6528 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006532 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6533 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6534 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006536 Arguments:
6537 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6538 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006540 Example:
6541 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6542 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6545 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6546 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6551 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6552 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6553 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6554 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006556 Example:
6557 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6558 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6560 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6561 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6562 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6564 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6565 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006567http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6570 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6571 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6572 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6573 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6576 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006578 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6579 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6580 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6581 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6582 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6583 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6584 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6585 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6586 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006588http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6591 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6592 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6593 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6594 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6595 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6596 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6601 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6602 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6607 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6608 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6609 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6610 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6611 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6612 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6613 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6618 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6619 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6620 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6621 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6622 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624 Example :
6625 # prepend the host name before the path
6626 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006627
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006628http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6629
6630 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6631 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6632 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6637 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6638 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6639 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6640 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6645 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6646 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6647 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6648 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6649 values have higher priority.
6650 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6651 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6652 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6653 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6654 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6659 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6660 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6661 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6662 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6663 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6664 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006667
6668 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6670 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6673 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6674 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6675 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006676 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6677 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678
6679 Arguments :
6680 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6681 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006682
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006683 See also "option forwardfor".
6684
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006685 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6687 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6688
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006689 # After the masking this will track connections
6690 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6691 http-request track-sc0 src
6692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6694 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6695
6696http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6697
6698 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6699 expression.
6700
6701 Arguments:
6702 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6703 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006704
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006705 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6707 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6708
6709 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6710 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6711 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6712
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006713http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006714 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6715
6716 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6717 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6718 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6719 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6720 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6721
6722 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6723 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6724 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6725 results.
6726
6727 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006728 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6729 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006731http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6732
6733 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6734 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6735 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6736 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6737 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6738 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6739 information from the request.
6740
6741 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6742
6743http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6744
6745 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6746 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6747 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6748 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6749 path and the query string.
6750 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6751
6752http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6753
6754 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6755 inline.
6756
6757 Arguments:
6758 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6759 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6760 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6761 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6762 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6763 (request and response)
6764 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6765 processing
6766 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6767 processing
6768 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6769 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6770 and '_'.
6771
6772 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6773 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006774
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006775 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006776 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006778http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6779 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6782 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6783 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6784 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6785 agent name must be used.
6786
6787 Arguments:
6788 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6789
6790 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6791 configuration.
6792
6793http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6794
6795 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6796 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6797 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6798 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6799 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6800 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6801 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6802 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6803 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6804 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6805 action.
6806 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6807 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6808 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6809 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6810 you fully understand how it works.
6811
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006812http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6813
6814 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6815 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6816 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6817 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6818 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006819 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006820 processing.
6821
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006822 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006823 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6824 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6825 rules evaluation.
6826
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006827http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6828http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6829 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6830 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6831 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6832 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833
6834 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6835 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6836 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006837 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6838 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6839 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6840 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6841 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6842 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6843 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6844 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6845 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6846 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006847 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006848 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6849 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6850 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6851 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6852 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006853
6854http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6855http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6856http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857
6858 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6859 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6860 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6861 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006862 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006863 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6864 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6865 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6866 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6867 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6868 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6869 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6870
6871 Arguments :
6872 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6873 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6874 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6875 select which table entry to update the counters.
6876
6877 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6878 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6879 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6880 that table until the session ends.
6881
6882 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6883 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6884 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6885 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6886 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6887 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6888 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6889 useful information.
6890
6891 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6892 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6893 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6894 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6895 checks that make use of it.
6896
6897http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006900
6901 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006902 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006903
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006904http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6905
6906 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6907 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6908 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6909 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6910 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6911 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6912
6913 Arguments :
6914 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6915
6916 Example:
6917 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6918
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006919http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6920 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6921
6922 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6923 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6924 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6925 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6926 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6927 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6928 http-buffer-request".
6929
6930 Arguments :
6931
6932 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6933 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6934
6935 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006936 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006937 bytes.
6938
6939 Example:
6940 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6941
6942 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006944http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6947 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6948 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006949
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006951http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006952 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6953
6954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6955 no | yes | yes | yes
6956
6957 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6958 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6959 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6960 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6961 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6962 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006964 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6965 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006969 Example:
6970 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006972 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006974 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6975 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006977 Example:
6978 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006982 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6983 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006985 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6986 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006990 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6991 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6992 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6993 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6994 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6995 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6996 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6997 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006999http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007001 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7002 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7003 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7004 example, or to pass some internal information.
7005 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7006 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7007 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7012 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007014http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007015
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007016 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007018http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007020 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7021 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7022 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7023 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7024 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7025 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7026 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7029 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7030 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7031 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7032 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007033
7034 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7035 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7036 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7037 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7042 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7043 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7044 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7045 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7046 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007047
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007048http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007049
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007050 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7051 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7052 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7053 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7054 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7059 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7060 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7061 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7062 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7063 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007064
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007065http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7066http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7067 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7068 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7069 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7070 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007071
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007072 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7073 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7074 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007075 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007076 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7077 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7078 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007079 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007080 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7085 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7086 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7087 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7088 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7089 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7092 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007093
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007094 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7095 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 Example:
7098 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007100 # applied to:
7101 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103 # outputs:
7104 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007106 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007108http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7109 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007110
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007111 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007112 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007114 Example:
7115 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117 # applied to:
7118 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120 # outputs:
7121 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007122
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7124 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7125 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007126 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007127 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7128
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007129 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007130 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7131 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007132 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007133 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007134 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007135 are followed to create the response :
7136
7137 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7138 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7139 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7140 ignored.
7141
7142 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7143 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007144 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007145 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7146 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007147
7148 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7149 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7150 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007151 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7152 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007153
7154 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7155 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7156 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007157 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007158 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007159 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007160
7161 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7162 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7163 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7164 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7165 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7166 as a raw content.
7167
7168 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7169 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7170 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7171 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7172 considered as a raw string.
7173
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007174 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7175 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7176 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7177 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7178
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007179 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7180 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007181 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007182
7183 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7184
7185 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007186 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007187 if { status eq 404 }
7188
7189 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7190 string "This is the end !" \
7191 if { status eq 500 }
7192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7194http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7197 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7198 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007199
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007200http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7201 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007202
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007203 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7204 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7205 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7206 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7211 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7212 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7213 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7214 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216 Arguments:
7217 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7220 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7225 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7226 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007228http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7229
7230 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7231 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7232 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7233 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7234 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7235
7236http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7237
7238 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7239 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7240 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7241 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7242 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7243 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7244 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7245 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7246 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7247
7248http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7249
7250 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7251 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7252 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7253 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7254 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7255 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7256 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7257
7258http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7259
7260 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7261 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7262 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7263 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7264 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7265 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7266 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7267 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7268
7269http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7271
7272 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7273 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7274 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7275 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007276
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007277 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007278 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7279 http-response set-status 431
7280 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7281 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007282
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007283http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007284
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007285 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7286 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7287 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7288 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7289 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7290 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7291 based on some information from the request.
7292
7293 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7294
7295http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7296
7297 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7298 inline.
7299
7300 Arguments:
7301 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7302 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7306 (request and response)
7307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7308 processing
7309 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7310 processing
7311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7312 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7313 and '_'.
7314
7315 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7316 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007317
7318 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007319 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7324 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7325 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7326 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7327 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7328 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7329 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7330 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7331 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7332 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7333 action.
7334 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7335 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7336 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7337 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7338 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007339
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007340http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7341
7342 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7343 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7344 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7345 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7346 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007347 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007348 processing.
7349
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007350 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007351 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007352 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007353 rules evaluation.
7354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7356http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7357http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007359 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7360 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7361 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7362 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7363 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7364 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7365
7366http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7367
7368 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7369 about <var-name>.
7370
7371 Example:
7372 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7373
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007374http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7376
7377 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7378 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7379 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7380 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7381 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7382 buffer is full.
7383
7384 Arguments :
7385
7386 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7387 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7388
7389 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007390 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007391 bytes.
7392
7393 Example:
7394 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007395
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007396http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7397 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7398
7399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 yes | no | yes | yes
7401
7402 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007403 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7404 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7405 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007406
7407 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7408
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007409 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7410 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7411 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7412 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7413 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7414 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7415 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7416 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7417 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7418 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007419
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007420 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7421 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7422 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7423 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7424 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7425 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7426 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007427 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7428 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7429 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7430 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7431 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7432 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007433
7434 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7435 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7436 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7437 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7438 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7439 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7440 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7441 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007442 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007443 downsides of rare connection failures.
7444
7445 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7446 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7447 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7448 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7449 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7450 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007451 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007452 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7453 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7454 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7455 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7456 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7457
7458 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007459 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7460 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7461 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7462 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007463
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007464 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7465 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007466
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007467 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007468
7469 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7470 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7471 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7472
7473 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7474
7475
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007476http-send-name-header [<header>]
7477 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007480 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007481 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7482
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007483 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7484 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7485 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7486 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7487 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7488 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7489 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7490 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7491 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7492 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7493 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7494 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7495 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7496 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7497 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7498 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007499
7500 See also : "server"
7501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007502id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007503 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7505 no | yes | yes | yes
7506 Arguments : none
7507
7508 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7509 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7510 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007511
7512
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007513ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7514 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007516 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007517
7518 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7519 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7520 and running).
7521
7522 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7523 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7524 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007525 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007526 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7527
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007528 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7529 "unless" condition is met.
7530
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007531 Example:
7532 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7533 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7534 ignore-persist if url_static
7535
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007536 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7537
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007538load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7539 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 yes | no | yes | yes
7542
7543 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7544 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7545 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007546 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007547 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7548 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7549 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7550 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007552 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007553 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007554 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007555
7556 Arguments:
7557 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7558 named "server-state-file".
7559
7560 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7561 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7562 name is used as a file name.
7563
7564 none don't load any stat for this backend
7565
7566 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007567 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7568 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7569 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007570 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007571 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007572
7573 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7574 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007576 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007578 global
7579 stats socket /tmp/socket
7580 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007581
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007582 defaults
7583 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007584
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007585 backend bk
7586 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7587 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007588
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007589
7590 Then one can run :
7591
7592 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7593
7594 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7595
7596 1
7597 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7598 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7599 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7600
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007601 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007602
7603 global
7604 stats socket /tmp/socket
7605 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7606
7607 defaults
7608 load-server-state-from-file local
7609
7610 backend bk
7611 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7612 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7613
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007614
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007615 Then one can run :
7616
7617 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7618
7619 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7620
7621 1
7622 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7623 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7624 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7625
7626 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7627 "show servers state"
7628
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007629
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007630log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007631log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007632 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007633no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007634 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7636 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007637
7638 Prefix :
7639 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7640 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7641 prefix does not allow arguments.
7642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007643 Arguments :
7644 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7645 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7646 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7647 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7648 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7649 parameter.
7650
7651 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7652 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7653
7654 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7655 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7656 standard syslog port).
7657
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007658 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7659 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7660 standard syslog port).
7661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007662 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7663 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7664 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007665 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007666
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007667 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7668 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7669 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7670 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7671 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7672 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7673 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7674 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7675 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7676 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7677 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7678 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7679 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7680 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7681 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7682 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007683 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7684 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007685
7686 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7687 and "fd@2", see above.
7688
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007689 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7690 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7691 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7692 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7693 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7694 having the logs instantly available.
7695
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007696 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7697 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7698 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7699
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007700 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7701 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007702
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007703 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7704 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7705 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7706 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7707 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7708 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7709 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7710 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7711 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7712 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007713 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007714
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007715 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7716 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7717 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7718 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7719 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7720
7721 <sample_size>
7722 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7723 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7724 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7725 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7726 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7727
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007728 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7729 one of the following :
7730
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007731 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7732 field is stripped. This is the default.
7733 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7734 rfc3164.
7735
7736 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007737 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7738
7739 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7740 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7741
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007742 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7743 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7744 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7745 designed to be used with a local log server.
7746
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007747 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7748 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7749 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7750 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7751 systemd logger consumes.
7752
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007753 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7754 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7755 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7756 used with a local log server.
7757
7758 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7759 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7760 designed to be used with a local log server.
7761
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007762 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7763 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7764 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7765 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007767 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7768
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007769 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7770 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7771 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7772
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007773 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7774 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7775 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7776 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007777
7778 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7779 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7780 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007781 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7782 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7783 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7784 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7785 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007786
7787 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7788
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007789 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7790 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7791 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007792
7793 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7794 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7795 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7796 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7797
7798 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7799 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007800
7801 Example :
7802 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007803 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7804 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7805 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007806 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007807 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7808 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007809 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007810
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007811
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007812log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007813 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7815 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007816
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007817 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7818 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7819 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7820 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7821 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007822
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007823 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7824 "option httplog" directives.
7825
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007826log-format-sd <string>
7827 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | yes | yes | no
7830
7831 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7832 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7833 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7834 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7835 which covers the log format string in depth.
7836
7837 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7838 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7839
7840 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7841 log format to "rfc5424".
7842
7843 Example :
7844 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7845
7846
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007847log-tag <string>
7848 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 yes | yes | yes | yes
7851
7852 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7853 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7854 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7855 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7856 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7857 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7858 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7859 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7860 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007861
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007862max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7863 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7865 yes | no | yes | yes
7866
7867 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7868 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7869 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7870 servers.
7871
7872 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7873 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7874 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7875 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7876 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007877 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007878 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7879 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7880 picking a different server.
7881
7882 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7883 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7884 even if they have to be queued.
7885
7886 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7887 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7888
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007889max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7890 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7891 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7892 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007893
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007894maxconn <conns>
7895 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7897 yes | yes | yes | no
7898 Arguments :
7899 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7900 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7901 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7902 closes.
7903
7904 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7905 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7906 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7907 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007908 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7909 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7910 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7911 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007912
7913 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7914 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7915 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7916
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007917 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7918 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007919
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007920 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7921
7922
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007923mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | yes | yes | yes
7927 Arguments :
7928 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7929 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7930 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7931 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7932
7933 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7934 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7935 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7936 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7937 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7938
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007939 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7940 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7941 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007942
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007943 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007944 defaults http_instances
7945 mode http
7946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007948monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007949 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007952 Arguments :
7953 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7954 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007955 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007956 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7957 backend and its backup.
7958
7959 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7960 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7961 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7962 servers in a list of backends.
7963
7964 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7965 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7966 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7967 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7968 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7969 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7970 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007971 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7972 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007973
7974 Example:
7975 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007976 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007977 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7978 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7979 monitor-uri /site_alive
7980 monitor fail if site_dead
7981
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007982 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007983
7984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985monitor-uri <uri>
7986 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 yes | yes | yes | no
7989 Arguments :
7990 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7991 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7992
7993 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7994 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7995 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7996 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7997 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7998 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7999 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8000 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8001
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008002 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008003 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8004 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8005 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8006 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8007 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8008 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008010 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8011 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8012 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8013 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8014
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008015 Example :
8016 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
8017 frontend www
8018 mode http
8019 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8020
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008021 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008023
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008024option abortonclose
8025no option abortonclose
8026 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | no | yes | yes
8029 Arguments : none
8030
8031 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8032 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8033 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8034 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008035 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008036 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8037 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8038 encountered while delivering the response.
8039
8040 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8041 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8042 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8043 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8044 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8045 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008046 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008047 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008048 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8050 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8051 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8052
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008053 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8054 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008055 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8056 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8057 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8058 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8059 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8060 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008061 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008062
8063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8065
8066 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8067
8068
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008069option accept-invalid-http-request
8070no option accept-invalid-http-request
8071 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8073 yes | yes | yes | no
8074 Arguments : none
8075
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008076 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008077 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008078 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008079 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8080 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8081 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8082 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8083 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008084 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8085 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8086 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8087 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008088 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008089 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008090 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8091 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8092 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008093
8094 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8095 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8096 been confirmed.
8097
8098 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8099 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008100 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8101 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008102 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8103
8104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8106
8107 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8108 stats socket.
8109
8110
8111option accept-invalid-http-response
8112no option accept-invalid-http-response
8113 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | no | yes | yes
8116 Arguments : none
8117
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008118 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008119 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008120 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008121 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8122 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8123 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8124 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8125 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008126 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8127 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8128 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008129
8130 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8131 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8132 been confirmed.
8133
8134 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8135 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8136 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8137 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8138
8139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8141
8142 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8143 stats socket.
8144
8145
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008146option allbackups
8147no option allbackups
8148 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | no | yes | yes
8151 Arguments : none
8152
8153 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8154 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8155 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8156 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8157 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8158 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8159 order between the backup servers anymore.
8160
8161 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8162 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8163
8164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8166
8167
8168option checkcache
8169no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008170 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 yes | no | yes | yes
8173 Arguments : none
8174
8175 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8176 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008177 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008178 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8179 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008180 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008181
8182 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008183 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008184 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008185 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8186 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008187 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008189 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8190 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008191 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008192 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8193 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008194 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008195 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8197 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8198 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8199 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8200 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8202 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8203 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8204
8205 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008206 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8207 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8208 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8209 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210
8211 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8212 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008213 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008215
8216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8218
8219
8220option clitcpka
8221no option clitcpka
8222 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8224 yes | yes | yes | no
8225 Arguments : none
8226
8227 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8228 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008229 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008230 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8231
8232 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8233 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8234 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8235 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8236
8237 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8238 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8239 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8240 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8241 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8242
8243 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8244
8245 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8246 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8247 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8248
8249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8251
8252 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8253
8254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008255option contstats
8256 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8258 yes | yes | yes | no
8259 Arguments : none
8260
8261 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8262 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8263 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8264 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008265 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8266 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8267 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8268 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8269 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008270
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008271option disable-h2-upgrade
8272no option disable-h2-upgrade
8273 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8274 connection.
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | yes | yes | no
8277 Arguments : none
8278
8279 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8280 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8281 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8282 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008283 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8284 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8285 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8286 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8287 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8288 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008289
8290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008292
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008293option dontlog-normal
8294no option dontlog-normal
8295 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | yes | yes | no
8298 Arguments : none
8299
8300 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8301 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8302 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8303 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8304 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8305 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8306 logged.
8307
8308 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8309 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8310 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008312 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008313 logging.
8314
8315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008316option dontlognull
8317no option dontlognull
8318 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 yes | yes | yes | no
8321 Arguments : none
8322
8323 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8324 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8325 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8326 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8327 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8328 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008329 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8330 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8331 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008332
8333 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008334 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008335 would not be logged.
8336
8337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8339
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008340 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008341 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008342
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008343
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008344option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008345 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | yes | yes | yes
8348 Arguments :
8349 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8350 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008351 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008352 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008353
8354 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8355 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8356 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8357 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8358 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8359 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8360 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008361 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8362 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8363 possible that the client has already brought one.
8364
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008365 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008366 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008367 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008368 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008369 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008370 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008371
8372 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8373 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8374 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8375 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8376 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8377 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008378 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008379
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008380 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8381 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8382 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8383 are under the control of the end-user.
8384
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008385 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008386 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8387 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008388 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8389 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8390 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008391
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008392 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008393 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8394 frontend www
8395 mode http
8396 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8397
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008398 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8399 backend www
8400 mode http
8401 option forwardfor header X-Client
8402
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008403 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008404 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008405
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008406
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008407option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8408no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8409 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8411 yes | yes | yes | no
8412 Arguments : none
8413
8414 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8415 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8416 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8417 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8418 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8419 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8420 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8421
8422 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8423 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8424 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8425 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8426 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8427 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8428 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8429 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8430 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8431 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8432
8433 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8434
8435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8437
8438 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8439 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8440
8441
8442option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8443no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8444 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8446 yes | no | yes | yes
8447 Arguments : none
8448
8449 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8450 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8451 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8452 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8453 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8454 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8455 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8456
8457 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8458 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8459 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8460 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8461 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8462 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8463 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8464 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8465 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8466 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8467
8468 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8469
8470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8472
8473 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8474 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8475
8476
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008477option http-buffer-request
8478no option http-buffer-request
8479 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 yes | yes | yes | yes
8482 Arguments : none
8483
8484 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8485 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8486 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8487 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8488 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8489 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008490 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8491 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8492 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8493 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008494
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008495 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8496 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008497
8498
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008499option http-ignore-probes
8500no option http-ignore-probes
8501 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8503 yes | yes | yes | no
8504 Arguments : none
8505
8506 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8507 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8508 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8509 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8510 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8511 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8512 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8513 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8514 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008515 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8516 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008517 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8518
8519 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8520 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8521 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8522 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8523 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8524 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8525 are often the only way to detect them.
8526
8527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8529
8530 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8531
8532
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008533option http-keep-alive
8534no option http-keep-alive
8535 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 yes | yes | yes | yes
8538 Arguments : none
8539
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008540 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8541 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008542 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8543 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008544 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8545 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8546 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008547
8548 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8549 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008550 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8551 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8552 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8553 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8554 situations where this option may be useful :
8555
8556 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008558
8559 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8560 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8561
8562 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8563 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8564 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8565 request.
8566
8567 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8568 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008569 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8570 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8571 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008572
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008573 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8574 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8575 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8576 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8577 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8578 not set.
8579
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008580 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8581 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8582 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008583
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008584 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008585 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008586 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008587
8588
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008589option http-no-delay
8590no option http-no-delay
8591 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | yes | yes | yes
8594 Arguments : none
8595
8596 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8597 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8598 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8599 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8600 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8601 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8602 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8603 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8604 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8605 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8606 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8607 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8608 affected.
8609
8610 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8611 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8612 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8613 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8614 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8615 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8616 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8617 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8618 latency environments.
8619
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008620 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8621
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008622
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008623option http-pretend-keepalive
8624no option http-pretend-keepalive
8625 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008627 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008628 Arguments : none
8629
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008630 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008631 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8632 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8633 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8634 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8635 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8636 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8637 consider the response complete.
8638
8639 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8640 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8641 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8642 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008643 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008644 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8645
8646 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8647 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8648 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8649 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8650 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8651 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8652 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8653
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008654 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8655 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8656 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8657 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8658 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8659 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660
8661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8663
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008664 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008665 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008666
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008667
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008668option http-server-close
8669no option http-server-close
8670 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | yes | yes | yes
8673 Arguments : none
8674
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008675 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8676 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8677 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8678 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008679 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8680 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8681 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8682 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8683 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8684 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8685 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8686 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8687 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8688 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8689 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008690
8691 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8692 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8693 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8694 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008695 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8696 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008697
8698 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8699 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008700 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8701 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8702 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008703
8704 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8705 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8706
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008707 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8708 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008709
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008710option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008711no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008712 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8714 yes | yes | yes | no
8715 Arguments : none
8716
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008717 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008718 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8719 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8720 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8721 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8722 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8723 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8724
8725 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8726 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008727 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8728 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8729 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008730
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008731 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8732 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8733 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8734 front of an existing proxy.
8735
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008736 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8737
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008738 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008739
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008740option httpchk
8741option httpchk <uri>
8742option httpchk <method> <uri>
8743option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008744 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8746 yes | no | yes | yes
8747 Arguments :
8748 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8749 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8750 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8751 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8752 ones.
8753
8754 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8755 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8756 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8757
8758 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8759 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8760 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008761 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008762
8763 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8764 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8765 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8766 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8767 the lack of any response.
8768
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008769 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8770 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8771 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8772 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8773
8774 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8775 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8776 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008778 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8779 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008780 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008781 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008782 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008783
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008784 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8785 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8786 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8787 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8788
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008789 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008790 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8791 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8792 backend https_relay
8793 mode tcp
8794 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8795 http-check send hdr Host www
8796 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008797
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008798 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8799 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8800 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801
8802
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008803option httpclose
8804no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008805 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8807 yes | yes | yes | yes
8808 Arguments : none
8809
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008810 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8811 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8812 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8813 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008814 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008815
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008816 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8817 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008818 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008819 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8820 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008821
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008822 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8823 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8824 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008825
8826 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8827 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008828 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8829 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8830 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008831
8832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8834
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008835 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008836
8837
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008838option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008839 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008841 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008842 Arguments :
8843 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8844 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8845 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008847 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008848
8849 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8850 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8851 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8852 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8853 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8854 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8855 ports.
8856
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008857 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8858 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008859
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008860 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008862 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008863
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008864
8865option http_proxy
8866no option http_proxy
8867 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 yes | yes | yes | yes
8870 Arguments : none
8871
8872 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8873 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8874 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8875 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8876 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8877
8878 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8879 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008880 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8881 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008882
8883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8885
8886 Example :
8887 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8888 backend direct_forward
8889 option httpclose
8890 option http_proxy
8891
8892 See also : "option httpclose"
8893
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008894
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008895option independent-streams
8896no option independent-streams
8897 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8899 yes | yes | yes | yes
8900 Arguments : none
8901
8902 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8903 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8904 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8905 receive data or not.
8906
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008907 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008908 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8909 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8910 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8911 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8912 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8913 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8914 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8915 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8916 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8917 socket buffers.
8918
8919 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8920 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8921 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8922 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8923 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8924
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008925 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008926
8927
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008928option ldap-check
8929 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8931 yes | no | yes | yes
8932 Arguments : none
8933
8934 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8935 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8936 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8937 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8938
8939 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8940 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8941
8942 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8943 configure it.
8944
8945 Example :
8946 option ldap-check
8947
8948 See also : "option httpchk"
8949
8950
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008951option external-check
8952 Use external processes for server health checks
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 yes | no | yes | yes
8955
8956 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8957 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8958 command".
8959
8960 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8961
8962 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8963
8964
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008965option log-health-checks
8966no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008967 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8969 yes | no | yes | yes
8970 Arguments : none
8971
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008972 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8973 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8974 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008975
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008976 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8977 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8978 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8979 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8980 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008982 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008983 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008984
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008985 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8986 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8987 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008988
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008989
8990option log-separate-errors
8991no option log-separate-errors
8992 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8994 yes | yes | yes | no
8995 Arguments : none
8996
8997 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8998 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8999 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9000 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9001 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9002 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9003 provides very important information.
9004
9005 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9006 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9007 error logs.
9008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009010 logging.
9011
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009012
9013option logasap
9014no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009015 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9017 yes | yes | yes | no
9018 Arguments : none
9019
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009020 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9021 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9022 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9023 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9024
9025 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9026 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9027 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9028 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9029 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009030 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009031 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9032 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9033 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9034 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009035 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009036
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009037 Examples :
9038 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9039 mode http
9040 option httplog
9041 option logasap
9042 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9043
9044 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9045 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9046 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9047 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009050 logging.
9051
9052
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009053option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009054 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009057 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009058 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9059 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009060 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9061 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009062
9063 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9064 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009066 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9067 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9068 in the MySQL table, like this :
9069
9070 USE mysql;
9071 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9072 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9073
9074 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009075 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009076 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9077 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9078 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9079 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9080 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9081 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9082 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9083
9084 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9085 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009086
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009087 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009088
9089 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9090 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9091 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9092 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009093 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9094 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009095
9096 See also: "option httpchk"
9097
9098
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009099option nolinger
9100no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009101 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9103 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009104 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009105
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009107 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9108 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9109 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9110 connections.
9111
9112 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9113 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009114 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9115 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9116 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9117 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9118 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9119 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9120 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9121 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9122 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9123 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9124 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9125 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9126 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009127
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009128 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9129 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9130 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9131 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9132 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009133
9134 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9135 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009136 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009137 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009138 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009139
9140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9142
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009143 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9144 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009145
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009146option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9147 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 yes | yes | yes | yes
9150 Arguments :
9151 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9152 matching <network>
9153 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9154 header name.
9155
9156 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9157 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9158 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9159 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9160 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9161 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9162 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9163 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9164 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9165 possible that the client has already brought one.
9166
9167 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9168 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9169 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9170 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9171 header and requires different one.
9172
9173 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9174 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9175 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009176 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9177 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9178 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9179 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9180 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009181
9182 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9183 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9184 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9185 both are defined.
9186
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009187 Examples :
9188 # Original Destination address
9189 frontend www
9190 mode http
9191 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9192
9193 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9194 backend www
9195 mode http
9196 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009198 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009199
9200
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009201option persist
9202no option persist
9203 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009207
9208 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9209 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9210 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9211 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9212 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9213 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9214 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9215 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9216 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9217 redirected to another valid server.
9218
9219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9221
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009222 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009223
9224
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009225option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9226 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | no | yes | yes
9229 Arguments :
9230 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9231 PostgreSQL server.
9232
9233 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9234 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9235 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9236 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9237
9238 See also: "option httpchk"
9239
9240
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009241option prefer-last-server
9242no option prefer-last-server
9243 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9245 yes | no | yes | yes
9246 Arguments : none
9247
9248 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9249 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9250 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9251 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9252 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9253 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9254 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9255 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9256 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009257 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9258 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009259 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9260 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9261 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009262 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9263 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9264 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009265
9266 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9267 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9268
9269 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9270
9271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009272option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009273option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009274no option redispatch
9275 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9277 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009278 Arguments :
9279 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9280 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9281 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009282 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009283 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009284 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009285 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9286 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9287 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009289
9290 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9291 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9292 be able to access the service anymore.
9293
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009294 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9295 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009296
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009297 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9298 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9299 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9300 following order:
9301
9302 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9303
9304 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9305 list, or
9306
9307 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9308
9309 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9310 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9311
9312 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9313 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9314 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9315 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9316
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009317 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009318 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9319 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9323
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009324 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009325
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009326
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009327option redis-check
9328 Use redis health checks for server testing
9329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9330 yes | no | yes | yes
9331 Arguments : none
9332
9333 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9334 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9335 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9336 find the "+PONG" response message.
9337
9338 Example :
9339 option redis-check
9340
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009341 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009342
9343
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009344option smtpchk
9345option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9346 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009349 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009350 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009351 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009352 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9353
9354 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9355 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9356 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9357
9358 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9359 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9360 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9361 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9362 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9363 dead server.
9364
9365 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9366 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009367 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009368 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9369
9370 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9371 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9372 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9373 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009374 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009375
9376 Example :
9377 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9378
9379 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009382option socket-stats
9383no option socket-stats
9384
9385 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9387 yes | yes | yes | no
9388
9389 Arguments : none
9390
9391
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009392option splice-auto
9393no option splice-auto
9394 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9396 yes | yes | yes | yes
9397 Arguments : none
9398
9399 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9400 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009401 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009402 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009403 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009404 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9405 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9406 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9407 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9408
9409 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9410 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9411 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9412 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9413 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9414 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9415 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9416 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9417 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9418 keyword.
9419
9420 Example :
9421 option splice-auto
9422
9423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9425
9426 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9427 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9428
9429
9430option splice-request
9431no option splice-request
9432 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9434 yes | yes | yes | yes
9435 Arguments : none
9436
9437 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009438 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009439 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9440 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9441 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9442 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9443
9444 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9445
9446 Example :
9447 option splice-request
9448
9449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9451
9452 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9453 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9454
9455
9456option splice-response
9457no option splice-response
9458 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9460 yes | yes | yes | yes
9461 Arguments : none
9462
9463 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009464 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009465 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9466 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9467 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9468 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9469
9470 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9471
9472 Example :
9473 option splice-response
9474
9475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9477
9478 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9479 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9480
9481
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009482option spop-check
9483 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 no | no | no | yes
9486 Arguments : none
9487
9488 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9489 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9490 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9491 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9492
9493 Example :
9494 option spop-check
9495
9496 See also : "option httpchk"
9497
9498
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009499option srvtcpka
9500no option srvtcpka
9501 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9503 yes | no | yes | yes
9504 Arguments : none
9505
9506 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9507 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009508 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009509 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9510
9511 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9512 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9513 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9514 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9515
9516 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9517 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9518 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9519 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9520 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9521
9522 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9523
9524 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9525 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9526 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9527
9528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9530
9531 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9532
9533
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009534option ssl-hello-chk
9535 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9537 yes | no | yes | yes
9538 Arguments : none
9539
9540 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9541 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9542 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9543 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9544 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9545 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9546 hello message.
9547
9548 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9549 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9550 messages, which is appreciable.
9551
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009552 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9553 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9554 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009555
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009556 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9557
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009558
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009559option tcp-check
9560 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9562 yes | no | yes | yes
9563
9564 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9565 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9566
9567 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9568 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9569 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9570
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009571 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9573 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9574 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9575 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9576 only.
9577
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009578 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009579 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9580 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9581 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9582 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9583
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009584 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009585 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9586 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009587 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009588 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9589 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9590 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9591 the respective protocols.
9592 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009593 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009594
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009595 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009596
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009597 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9598 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9599 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9600 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009601
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009602 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9603 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9604 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009605
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009606
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009609 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009610 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009611
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009612 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009613 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009614 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009615
9616 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9617 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009619 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009620 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009621 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009622 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009623 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9625 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009626 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009627 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9628 tcp-check expect string +OK
9629
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009630 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009631 (send many headers before analyzing)
9632 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009633 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9635 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9636 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9637 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009638 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009639
9640
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009641 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009642
9643
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009644option tcp-smart-accept
9645no option tcp-smart-accept
9646 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9648 yes | yes | yes | no
9649 Arguments : none
9650
9651 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9652 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9653 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9654 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9655 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9656 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9657
9658 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9659 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9660 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9661 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9662
9663 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9664 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9665 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009667
9668 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9669 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9670 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9671
9672 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9673 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9674 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9675
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009676 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9677
9678
9679option tcp-smart-connect
9680no option tcp-smart-connect
9681 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9683 yes | no | yes | yes
9684 Arguments : none
9685
9686 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9687 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9688 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9689 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9690 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9691
9692 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9693 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9694 complex.
9695
9696 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9697 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9698 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9699
9700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9702
9703 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9704
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009705
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009706option tcpka
9707 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9709 yes | yes | yes | yes
9710 Arguments : none
9711
9712 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9713 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009714 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009715 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9716
9717 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9718 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9719 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9720 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9721
9722 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9723 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9724 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9725 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9726 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9727
9728 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9729
9730 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9731 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9732 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9733 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9734 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9735 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9736 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9737 backends.
9738
9739 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9740
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009741
9742option tcplog
9743 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009745 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009746 Arguments : none
9747
9748 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9749 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9750 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9751 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9752 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9753 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9754 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9755 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9756
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009757 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009759 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009760
9761
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009762option transparent
9763no option transparent
9764 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009766 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009767 Arguments : none
9768
9769 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9770 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9771 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9772 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9773 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9774 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9775 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9776 appropriate server.
9777
9778 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9779 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9780
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009781 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009782 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009783
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009784
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009785external-check command <command>
9786 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9788 yes | no | yes | yes
9789
9790 Arguments :
9791 <command> is the external command to run
9792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009793 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9794
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009795 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009796
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009797 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9798 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9799 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9800 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9801 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9802 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009803
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009804 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9805
9806 Environment variables :
9807 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9808 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9809
9810 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9811
9812 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9813
9814 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9815 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9816 for a UNIX socket).
9817
9818 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9819
9820 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9821
9822 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9823
9824 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9825
9826 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9827
9828 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9829 socket).
9830
9831 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9832 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9833
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009834 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9835
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009836 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9837 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9838 failed.
9839
9840 Example :
9841 external-check command /bin/true
9842
9843 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9844
9845
9846external-check path <path>
9847 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 yes | no | yes | yes
9850
9851 Arguments :
9852 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9853
9854 The default path is "".
9855
9856 Example :
9857 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9858
9859 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9860 "external-check command"
9861
9862
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009863persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009864persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009865 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9867 yes | no | yes | yes
9868 Arguments :
9869 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009870 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9871 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009872
9873 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9874 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009875 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009876 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9877 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9878 forwarded to this server.
9879
9880 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9881 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9882 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009883 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009884 a single "listen" section.
9885
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009886 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9887 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9888 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9889
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009890 Example :
9891 listen tse-farm
9892 bind :3389
9893 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9894 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9895 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9896 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9897 persist rdp-cookie
9898 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009899 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009900 balance rdp-cookie
9901 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9902 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9903
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009904 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9905 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009906
9907
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009908rate-limit sessions <rate>
9909 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9911 yes | yes | yes | no
9912 Arguments :
9913 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9914 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9915
9916 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9917 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9918 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9919 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9920 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9921 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9922
9923 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9924 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9925 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9926 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9927
9928 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9929 listen smtp
9930 mode tcp
9931 bind :25
9932 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009933 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009934
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009935 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9936 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9937 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009938
9939 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9940
9941
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009942redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9943redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9944redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009945 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 no | yes | yes | yes
9948
9949 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009950 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009951
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009952 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009953 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009954 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9955 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9956 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009957
9958 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9959 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9960 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9961 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9962 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009963 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9964 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9965 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9966 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009967
9968 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9969 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9970 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9971 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9972 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9973 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009974 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009975 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009976 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9977 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9978 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009979
9980 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009981 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9982 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9983 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009984 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009985 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9986 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9987 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9988 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009989
9990 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009991 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992
9993 - "drop-query"
9994 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9995 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9996 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9997 with a location-type redirect.
9998
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009999 - "append-slash"
10000 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10001 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10002 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10003 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10004
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010005 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10006 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10007 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10008 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10009 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10010 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10011 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10012
10013 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10014 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10015 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10016 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10017 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10018 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10019 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010020
10021 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10022 acl clear dst_port 80
10023 acl secure dst_port 8080
10024 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010025 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010026 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010027 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10028
10029 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010030 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10031 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10032 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010033 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010034
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010035 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10036 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10037 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10038
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010039 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010040 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010041
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010042 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010043 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10044 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10045 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010047 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010049
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010050retries <value>
10051 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10053 yes | no | yes | yes
10054 Arguments :
10055 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10056 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10057 default value is 3.
10058
10059 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10060 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10061 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10062
10063 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010064 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10065 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010066
10067 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10068 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10069
10070 See also : "option redispatch"
10071
10072
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010073retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010074 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10075 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10076 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10078 yes | no | yes | yes
10079 Arguments :
10080 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10081 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10082 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10083 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10084
10085 none never retry
10086
10087 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10088 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10089
10090 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10091 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10092 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10093 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10094 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10095 processing the request.
10096
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010097 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10098 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10099 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10100 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10101 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10102 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10103 overflow attack for example).
10104
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010105 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10106 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10107 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10108 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10109 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10110 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10111 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10112 amplify denial of service attacks.
10113
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010114 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10115 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10116 considered to be safe to retry.
10117
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010118 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10119 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10120 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10121 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10122 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010123
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010124 all-retryable-errors
10125 retry request for any error that are considered
10126 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10127 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10128 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10129
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010130 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10131 not cumulative.
10132
10133 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10134 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10135 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10136 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10137
10138 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10139 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10140 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10141 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10142 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10143 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10144 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10145 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10146 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10147 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10148 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10149 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10150
10151 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10152 should not use this directive.
10153
10154 The default is "conn-failure".
10155
10156 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10157
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010158server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010159 Declare a server in a backend
10160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10161 no | no | yes | yes
10162 Arguments :
10163 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010164 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010165 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010166
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010167 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10168 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10169 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10170 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010171 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10172 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10173 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10174 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10175 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010176 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10177 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10178 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10179 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10180 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10181 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10182 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010183 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010184 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10185 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10186 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10187 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10188 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10189 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010190 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10191 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010192 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10193 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010194
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010195 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010196 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10197 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10198 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10199 adding this value to the client's port.
10200
10201 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10202 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010203 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010204
10205 Examples :
10206 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10207 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010208 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010209 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10210 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10211 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010212
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010213 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10214 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10215 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10216 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10217 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10218
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010219 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10220 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010221
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010222server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010223 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010224 this backend.
10225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10226 no | no | yes | yes
10227
10228 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10229 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10230 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10231 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10232 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010233
10234 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10235 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10236
10237 global
10238 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10239
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010240 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010241 load-server-state-from-file
10242
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010243 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010244 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010245
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010246server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10247 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10248 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10250 no | no | yes | yes
10251
10252 Arguments:
10253 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10254
10255 <num | range>
10256 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10257 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10258 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10259 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10260
10261 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10262
10263 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10264
10265 <params*>
10266 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10267 keyword.
10268
10269 Examples:
10270 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10271 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10272 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10273
10274 # or
10275 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10276
10277 # would be equivalent to:
10278 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10279 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10280 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10281
10282
10283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010284source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010285source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010286source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010287 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | no | yes | yes
10290 Arguments :
10291 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10292 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010293
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010294 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010295 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10296 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10297 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10298 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10299 supported prefixes are :
10300 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10301 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10302 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010303 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010304 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10305 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010306
10307 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10308 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010309 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10310 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10311 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010312
10313 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10314 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10315 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10316 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10317 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10318 <addr>.
10319
10320 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10321 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10322 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10323 port.
10324
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010325 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10326 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10327 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10328 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010329 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010330 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10331 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10332 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10333 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10334 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10335 HTTP header.
10336
10337 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10338 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010339 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010340 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10341 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10342 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10343 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10344 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10345 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10346 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10347
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010348 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10349 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10350 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10351 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10352 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10353 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10354
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010355 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10356 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10357 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10358 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10359
10360 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10361 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10362 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10363 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10364 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10365 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10366
10367 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10368 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10369 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10370 there are two methods :
10371
10372 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10373 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10374 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10375 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10376 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10377 of the client ranges may be used.
10378
10379 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10380 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10381 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10382 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10383 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10384 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10385 same session.
10386
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010387 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10388 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10389 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010390 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010391
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010392 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10393
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394 Examples :
10395 backend private
10396 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10397 source 192.168.1.200
10398
10399 backend transparent_ssl1
10400 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10401 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10402
10403 backend transparent_ssl2
10404 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10405 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10406 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10407
10408 backend transparent_ssl3
10409 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10410 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10411 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10412
10413 backend transparent_smtp
10414 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10415 # with Tproxy version 4.
10416 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10417
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010418 backend transparent_http
10419 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10420 # proxy.
10421 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010423 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10425
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010426
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010427srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10428 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10429 the connection on the server side.
10430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10431 yes | no | yes | yes
10432 Arguments :
10433 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10434
10435 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10436 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010437 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10438 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010439
10440 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10441
10442
10443srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10444 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10445 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10446 server side.
10447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10448 yes | no | yes | yes
10449 Arguments :
10450 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10451 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10452 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10453 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10454
10455 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10456 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010457 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10458 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010459
10460 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10461
10462
10463srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10464 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10466 yes | no | yes | yes
10467 Arguments :
10468 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10469 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10470 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10471 document.
10472
10473 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10474 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010475 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10476 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010477
10478 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10479
10480
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010481stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10482 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010484 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010485
10486 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10487 matched.
10488
10489 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10490 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10491
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010492 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10493 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010494 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010495
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010496 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10497 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10498 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10499 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010500
10501 Example :
10502 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10503 backend stats_localhost
10504 stats enable
10505 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10506
10507 Example :
10508 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10509 backend stats_auth
10510 stats enable
10511 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10512 stats admin if TRUE
10513
10514 Example :
10515 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10516 userlist stats-auth
10517 group admin users admin
10518 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10519 group readonly users haproxy
10520 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10521
10522 backend stats_auth
10523 stats enable
10524 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10525 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10526 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10527 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10528
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010529 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10530 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10531 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010532
10533
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010534stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10535 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010537 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010538 Arguments :
10539 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10540
10541 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10542
10543 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10544 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10545 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10546 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10547 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10548 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10549
10550 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10551 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10552 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010553 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010554
10555 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10556 report using "stats scope".
10557
10558 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10559 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10560 unobvious parameters.
10561
10562 Example :
10563 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10564 backend public_www
10565 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10566 stats enable
10567 stats hide-version
10568 stats scope .
10569 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010570 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010571 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10572 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10573
10574 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10575 backend private_monitoring
10576 stats enable
10577 stats uri /admin?stats
10578 stats refresh 5s
10579
10580 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10581
10582
10583stats enable
10584 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010586 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010587 Arguments : none
10588
10589 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10590 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10591 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10592 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10593 - stats auth : no authentication
10594 - stats scope : no restriction
10595
10596 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10597 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10598 unobvious parameters.
10599
10600 Example :
10601 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10602 backend public_www
10603 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10604 stats enable
10605 stats hide-version
10606 stats scope .
10607 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010609 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10610 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10611
10612 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10613 backend private_monitoring
10614 stats enable
10615 stats uri /admin?stats
10616 stats refresh 5s
10617
10618 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10619
10620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010621stats hide-version
10622 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010624 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010625 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010627 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10628 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10629 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10630 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10631 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10632 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010634 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10635 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10636 unobvious parameters.
10637
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010638 Example :
10639 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10640 backend public_www
10641 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010642 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010643 stats hide-version
10644 stats scope .
10645 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010646 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10648 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010649
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010650 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10651 backend private_monitoring
10652 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010653 stats uri /admin?stats
10654 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010655
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010656 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010657
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010658
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010659stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10660 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10661 Access control for statistics
10662
10663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10664 no | no | yes | yes
10665
10666 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10667 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10668 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10669 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10670 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10671 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10672
10673 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10674 instance.
10675
10676 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10677 about ACL usage.
10678
10679
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010680stats realm <realm>
10681 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010683 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010684 Arguments :
10685 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10686 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10687 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10688
10689 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10690 using a backslash ('\').
10691
10692 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10693 only related to authentication.
10694
10695 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10696 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10697 unobvious parameters.
10698
10699 Example :
10700 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10701 backend public_www
10702 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10703 stats enable
10704 stats hide-version
10705 stats scope .
10706 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010707 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010708 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10709 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10710
10711 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10712 backend private_monitoring
10713 stats enable
10714 stats uri /admin?stats
10715 stats refresh 5s
10716
10717 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10718
10719
10720stats refresh <delay>
10721 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724 Arguments :
10725 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10726 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10727 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10728 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10729 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10730 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10731
10732 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10733 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10734 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010735 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010736
10737 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10738 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10739 unobvious parameters.
10740
10741 Example :
10742 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10743 backend public_www
10744 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10745 stats enable
10746 stats hide-version
10747 stats scope .
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10751 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10752
10753 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10754 backend private_monitoring
10755 stats enable
10756 stats uri /admin?stats
10757 stats refresh 5s
10758
10759 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10760
10761
10762stats scope { <name> | "." }
10763 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010765 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010766 Arguments :
10767 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10768 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10769 section in which the statement appears.
10770
10771 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10772 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10773 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10774 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10775 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10776 exists.
10777
10778 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10779 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10780 unobvious parameters.
10781
10782 Example :
10783 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10784 backend public_www
10785 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10786 stats enable
10787 stats hide-version
10788 stats scope .
10789 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010790 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010791 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10792 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10793
10794 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10795 backend private_monitoring
10796 stats enable
10797 stats uri /admin?stats
10798 stats refresh 5s
10799
10800 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010802
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010803stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010804 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010806 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010808 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010809 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10810
10811 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10812 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10813
10814 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10815 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010816 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010817
10818 Example :
10819 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10820 backend private_monitoring
10821 stats enable
10822 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10823 stats uri /admin?stats
10824 stats refresh 5s
10825
10826 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10827 global section.
10828
10829
10830stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010831 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10833 yes | yes | yes | yes
10834 Arguments : none
10835
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010836 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010837 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10838 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10839 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10840 - IP (socket, server)
10841 - cookie (backend, server)
10842
10843 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10844 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010845 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010846
10847 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10848
10849
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010850stats show-modules
10851 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10853 yes | yes | yes | yes
10854 Arguments : none
10855
10856 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10857 values as a tooltip.
10858
10859 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10860 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10861 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10862
10863 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10864
10865
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010866stats show-node [ <name> ]
10867 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010869 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010870 Arguments:
10871 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10872 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10873
10874 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10875 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010876 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010877
10878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10880 unobvious parameters.
10881
10882 Example:
10883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10884 backend private_monitoring
10885 stats enable
10886 stats show-node Europe-1
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
10888 stats refresh 5s
10889
10890 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10891 section.
10892
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010893
10894stats uri <prefix>
10895 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010897 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010898 Arguments :
10899 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10900 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10901 query string.
10902
10903 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10904 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10905 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10906 possible to reach it in the application.
10907
10908 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010909 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010910 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10911 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10912 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10913 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10914
10915 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10916 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10917 an address or a port to statistics only.
10918
10919 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10920 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10921 unobvious parameters.
10922
10923 Example :
10924 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10925 backend public_www
10926 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10927 stats enable
10928 stats hide-version
10929 stats scope .
10930 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010931 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010932 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10933 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10934
10935 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10936 backend private_monitoring
10937 stats enable
10938 stats uri /admin?stats
10939 stats refresh 5s
10940
10941 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10942
10943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010944stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10945 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010947 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010948
10949 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010950 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010951 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010953 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10954
10955 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10956 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10957 the "stick-table" statement.
10958
10959 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10960 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10961 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10962 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10963 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10964
10965 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10966 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10967 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10968 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10969 transformation rules.
10970
10971 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10972 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10973 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10974 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10975 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10976 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10977 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10978
10979 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10980 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10981 ACL based conditions.
10982
10983 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10984 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10985 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10986 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10987
10988 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10989 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10990 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10991 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010993 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10994 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010996
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010997 Example :
10998 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10999 # last 30 minutes
11000 backend pop
11001 mode tcp
11002 balance roundrobin
11003 stick store-request src
11004 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11005 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11006 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11007
11008 backend smtp
11009 mode tcp
11010 balance roundrobin
11011 stick match src table pop
11012 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11013 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11014
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011015 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011016 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017
11018
11019stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11020 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11022 no | no | yes | yes
11023
11024 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11025 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11026 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11027 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11028
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011029 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11030 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011032
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011033 Examples :
11034 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011035 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011036
11037 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11038 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11039 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11040
11041
11042 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11043 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11044 backend http
11045 mode http
11046 balance roundrobin
11047 stick on src table https
11048 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11049 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11050 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11051
11052 backend https
11053 mode tcp
11054 balance roundrobin
11055 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11056 stick on src
11057 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11058 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11059
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011060 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011061
11062
11063stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11064 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11066 no | no | yes | yes
11067
11068 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011069 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011070 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011071 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011072 server is selected.
11073
11074 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11075 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11076 the "stick-table" statement.
11077
11078 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11079 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11080 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11081 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11082 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11083 address.
11084
11085 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11086 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11087 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11088 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11089 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11090 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11091 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11092 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11093 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11094 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11095
11096 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11097 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11098 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11099 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11100 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11101 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11102 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11103
11104 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11105 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11106 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11107 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11108
11109 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11110 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11111 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11112 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11113 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11114 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011115 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11116 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11117 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11118 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11119 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11120 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011121
11122 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11123 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11124 the request.
11125
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011126 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11127 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011128 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011129
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011130 Example :
11131 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11132 # last 30 minutes
11133 backend pop
11134 mode tcp
11135 balance roundrobin
11136 stick store-request src
11137 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11138 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11139 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11140
11141 backend smtp
11142 mode tcp
11143 balance roundrobin
11144 stick match src table pop
11145 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11146 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011148 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011149 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011150
11151
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011152stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011153 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011154 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011155 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011157 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158
11159 Arguments :
11160 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11161 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11162 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11163 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11164
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011165 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11166 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11167 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11168 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11171 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11172 instance.
11173
11174 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11175 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11176 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11177 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11178 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11179 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011180 to 32 characters.
11181
11182 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11183 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11184 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011185 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011186 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11187 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011188
11189 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011190 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11191 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11193 increase.
11194
11195 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011196 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11197 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11198 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011199
11200 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11201 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11202 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11203 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011204 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011205 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11206 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11207 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11208 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11209 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11210 parameter (see below).
11211
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011212 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11213 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11214 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11215 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11216 soft restart.
11217
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011218 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11219 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011220
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11222 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11223 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11224 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011225 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011226 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011227 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11228 if not expiration delay is specified.
11229
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011230 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11231 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11232 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11233 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11234 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11235 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11236 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11237 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11238 token.
11239
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011240 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11241 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11242 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11243 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011244 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11245 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11246 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11247 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11248 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11249 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11250 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11251 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11252 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11253 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11254 types and their arguments.
11255
11256 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11257 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11258 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11259 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11260
11261 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11262 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11263 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011264 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011265
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011266 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11267 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11268 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011269 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011270 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011271 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011273 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11274 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11275 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11276 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11277
11278 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11279 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11280 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11281 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11282 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11283 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11284
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011285 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11286 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11287 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11288 they were received.
11289
11290 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11291 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11292 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11293 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11294 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11295
11296 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11297 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11298 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11299 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11300 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11301
11302 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11303 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11304 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11305
11306 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11307 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11308 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11309 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11310 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11311
11312 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11313 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11314 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11315 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11316 the client side.
11317
11318 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11319 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11320 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11321 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11322 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11323 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11324 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11325
11326 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11327 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11328 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11329 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11330 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11331 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011332 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011333
11334 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11335 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11336 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11337 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11338 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11339 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11340
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011341 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11342 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11343 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11344 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11345 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11346
11347 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11348 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11349 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11350 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11351 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11352 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11353
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011354 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011355 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011356 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11357 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11358
11359 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11360 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11361 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11362 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11363 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11364 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11365 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11366 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11367 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11368 recommended for better fairness.
11369
11370 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011372 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11373 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11374
11375 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11376 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11377 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11378 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11379 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11380 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11381 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11382 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11383 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11384 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011385
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011386 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11387 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011388 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11389 reference it.
11390
11391 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11392 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011393 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11394 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11395 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011396
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011397 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11398 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11399 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11400 something that can be ignored.
11401
11402 Example:
11403 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11404 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11405 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11406 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11407
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011408 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011409 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011410
11411
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011412stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011413 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11415 no | no | yes | yes
11416
11417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011418 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011419 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011420 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011421 server is selected.
11422
11423 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11424 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11425 the "stick-table" statement.
11426
11427 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11428 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11429 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11430 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11431
11432 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11433 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11434 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11435 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11436 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11437 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011438 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011439 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11440 rules.
11441
11442 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11443 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11444 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11445 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11446 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11447 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11448 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11449
11450 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11451 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11452 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11453 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11454
11455 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11456 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11457 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11458 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11459 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11460 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011461 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11462 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11463 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11464 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11465 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11466 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11467 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11468 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11469 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011470
11471 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11472
11473 Example :
11474 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11475 backend https
11476 mode tcp
11477 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011478 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011479 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011480
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011481 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11482 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11483
11484 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11485 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11486 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11487
11488 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11489 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011490
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011491 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11492 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11493 # at offset 44.
11494
11495 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11496 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11497
11498 # Learn on response if server hello.
11499 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011500
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011501 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11502 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11503
11504 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11505 extraction.
11506
11507
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011508tcp-check comment <string>
11509 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11510 it fails.
11511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11512 yes | no | yes | yes
11513
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011514 Arguments :
11515 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11516 rule fails.
11517
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011518 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11519 user-friendly error reporting.
11520
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011521 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11522 "tcp-check expect".
11523
11524
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011525tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11526 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011527 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011528 Opens a new connection
11529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011530 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011531
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011532 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011533 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11534
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011535 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011536 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011537
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011538 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011539 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11540 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011541 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011542
11543 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011544
11545 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11546
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011547 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11548
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011549 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11550
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011551 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11552
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011553 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11554 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11555 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11556 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11557
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011558 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11559 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11560 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11561 haproxy -vv.
11562
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011563 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011564
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011565 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11566 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11567 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11568
11569 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11570 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11571 of the sequence.
11572
11573 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11574 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11575 do.
11576
11577 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11578 unset-var or comment rules.
11579
11580 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011581 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11582 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11583 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11584 option tcp-check
11585 tcp-check connect
11586 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11587 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11588 tcp-check send \r\n
11589 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11590 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11591 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11592 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11593 tcp-check send \r\n
11594 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11595 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11596
11597 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11598 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011599 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011600 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11601 tcp-check connect port 143
11602 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11603 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11604
11605 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11606
11607
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011608tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011609 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011610 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011611 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011612 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011614 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011615
11616 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011617 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11618
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011619 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11620 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11621 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11622 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11623 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11624 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11625 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11626 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11627 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11628 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11629
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011630 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011631 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11632 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011633 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11634 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11635 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11636
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011637 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11638 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11639 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011640 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11641 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011642 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11643 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011644 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11645 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011646 By default "L7OK" is used.
11647
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011648 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11649 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011650 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11651 supported :
11652 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11653 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011654 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11655 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11656 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11657 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11658 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011659
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011660 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011661 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011662 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11663 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11664 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11665 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011666 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11667
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011668 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11669 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11670 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11671 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11672
11673 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11674 informational message reported in logs if an error
11675 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11676 log-format string.
11677
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011678 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11679 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11680 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11681 followed by some converters.
11682
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011683 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11684 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11685 with the usual backslash ('\').
11686 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011687 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011688 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11689 used upper or lower case.
11690
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011691 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11692
11693 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11694 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11695 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11696 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11697 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11698 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11699 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11700 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11701
11702 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11703 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11704 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11705 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11706 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11707 expression.
11708
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011709 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11711 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11712 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11713 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11714 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11715
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011716 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11717 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11718 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11719 this exact hexadecimal string.
11720 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11721
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011722 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11723 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11724 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11725 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11726 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11727 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11728 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11729 size.
11730
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011731 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11732 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11733 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11734 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11735 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11736 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11737 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11738 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11739 in a binary string before matching the response's
11740 buffer.
11741
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011743 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011744 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11745 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11746 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11747 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11748 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11749 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11750 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11751 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11752 the null character.
11753
11754 Examples :
11755 # perform a POP check
11756 option tcp-check
11757 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11758
11759 # perform an IMAP check
11760 option tcp-check
11761 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11762
11763 # look for the redis master server
11764 option tcp-check
11765 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011766 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011767 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11768 tcp-check expect string role:master
11769 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11770 tcp-check expect string +OK
11771
11772
11773 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011774 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011775
11776
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011777tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11778tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11779 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11780 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011782 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011783
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011784 Arguments :
11785 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11786
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011787 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11788 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011789
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011790 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11791 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011792
11793 Examples :
11794 # look for the redis master server
11795 option tcp-check
11796 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11797 tcp-check expect string role:master
11798
11799 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011800 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011801
11802
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011803tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11804tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11805 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11806 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011809
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011810 Arguments :
11811 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011812
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011813 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11814 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011815
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011816 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11817 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11818 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011819
11820 Examples :
11821 # redis check in binary
11822 option tcp-check
11823 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11824 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11825
11826
11827 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011828 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011829
11830
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011831tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011832 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011834 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011835
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011836 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011837 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11838 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11841 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11842 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11843 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11844 and '-'.
11845
11846 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11847
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011848 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011849 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11850
11851
11852tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011853 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011855 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011856
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011857 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011858 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11859 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11860 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11861 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11862 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11863 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11864 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11865 and '-'.
11866
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011867 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011868 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11869
11870
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011871tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11872 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11874 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011876 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11877 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011879 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011880
11881 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11882 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011883 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11884 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11885 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11886 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11887 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11888 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011890 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11891 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11892 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11893 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011894
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011895 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011896 - accept :
11897 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11898 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11899 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011901 - reject :
11902 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11903 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11904 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11905 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11906 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11907 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11908 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11909 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11910 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11911 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11912 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011913 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011914
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011915 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11916 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11917 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11918 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11919 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11920 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11921 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11922 hosts.
11923
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011924 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11925 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11926 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11927 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11928 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11929 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11930 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11931 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11932
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011933 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11934 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11935 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11936 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11937 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11938 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11939 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11940 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11941 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011942 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11943 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011944
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011945 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011946 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011947 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11948 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11949 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011950 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011951 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011952 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11953 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11954 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11955 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11956 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11957 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11958 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011960 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011961 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011962 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011963 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011964 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11965 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11966 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011968 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11969 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11970 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11971 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011973 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11974 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11975 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11976 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11977 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011978 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11979 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11980 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11981 layer7 information is extracted.
11982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11984 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11985 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11986 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11987 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011988
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011989 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11990 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11991 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11992 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11993
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011994 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11995 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11996 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11997 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11998
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011999 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12000 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12001 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12002 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12003 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012004
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012005 - set-src <expr> :
12006 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12007 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12008 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012009 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012011 Arguments:
12012 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12013 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012014
12015 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012016 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12017
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012018 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12019 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012020
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012021 - set-src-port <expr> :
12022 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12023 expression.
12024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012025 Arguments:
12026 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12027 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012028
12029 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012030 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12031
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012032 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12033 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12034 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012035
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012036 - set-dst <expr> :
12037 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12038 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12039 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12040 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12041 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12042
12043 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12044 followed by some converters.
12045
12046 Example:
12047
12048 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12049 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12050
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012051 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12052 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12053
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012054 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12055 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12056 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12057 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12058
12059
12060 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12061 followed by some converters.
12062
12063 Example:
12064
12065 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12066
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012067 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12068 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12069 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12070
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012071 - "silent-drop" :
12072 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012074 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12075 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12076 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12077 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12078 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012079 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12080 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012081 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12082 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012083 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012084 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12085 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12086 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12087 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012089 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12090 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12091 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012093 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12094 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12095 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012097 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012098 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012099 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012101 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12102 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12103 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012105 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012106 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12107 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012108
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012109 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12110
12111 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12112
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012113 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12114
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012115 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012116
12117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012118tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12119 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012121 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012122 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012123 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12124 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012126 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012128 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012129 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12130 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012131 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12132 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012134 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12135 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12136 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12137 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012138 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12139 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12140 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12141 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12142 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12143 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012144 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012145 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012147 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12148 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12149 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12150 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012151
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012152 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012153 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012154 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012155 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12156 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012157 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012158 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012159 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012160 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012161 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012162 - set-dst <expr>
12163 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012164 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012165 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012166 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012167 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012168 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012169 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012171 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12172 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012173 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12174 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012175
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012176 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12177 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12178 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12179 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12180 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12181 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012183 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012184 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12185 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012186
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012187 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12188 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12189 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12190 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12191 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12192 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012194 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012195 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12196 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12197 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12198 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12199 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12200 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12201 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12202 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12203 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12204 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012205
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012206 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012207 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12208 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12209 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012210
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012211 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12212 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12213
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012214 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012215 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12216 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012217
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012218 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12219 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012220 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012223 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012225 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12227 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012229 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12230 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012231
12232 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12233 followed by some converters.
12234
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012235 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12236 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12237 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12238 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12239 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12240 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12241 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012242 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012243 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12244 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12245
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012246 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12247
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012248 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12249 <var-name>.
12250
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012251 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12252 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12253 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12254 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12255 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12256
12257 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12258 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12259 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12260 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12261 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12262 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12263 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12264 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12265 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12266 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12267 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12268
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012269 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12270 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12271 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12272 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12273 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12274
12275 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12276
12277 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12278
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012279 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12280 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12281 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12282 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12283 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12284 evaluated.
12285
12286 Example:
12287 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12288
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012289 Example:
12290
12291 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012292 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012293
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012294 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012295 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012296 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012297 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12298 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012299 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012300 tcp-request content reject
12301
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012302 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12303 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12304 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12305 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12306 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12307 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12308 ...
12309 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012312 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12313 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12314 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012315 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
12317 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12318 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12319 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012320 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012321 tcp-request content reject
12322
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012323 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012324 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012325 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012326 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012327 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12328 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012329
12330 Example:
12331 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12332 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012333 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012334
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012335 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012336 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012337
12338 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012339 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012340 # protecting all our sites
12341 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012342 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12343 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012344 ...
12345 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12346
12347 backend http_dynamic
12348 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012349 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012350 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012351 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012352 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012353 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012354 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012356 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012357
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012358 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12359 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360
12361
12362tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12363 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012365 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012366 Arguments :
12367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12369 as explained at the top of this document.
12370
12371 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12372 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12373 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12374 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12375 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12376
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012377 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12378 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12379 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12380 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12381
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012382 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12383 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012384 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012385 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012386 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12387 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12388 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12389 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012390
12391 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12392 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12393 it pass through unaffected.
12394
12395 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12396 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12397 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012398 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012399 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12400 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012401 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12402 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12403 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012404
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012405 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012406 "timeout client".
12407
12408
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012409tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12410 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12412 no | no | yes | yes
12413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012414 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12415 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012416
12417 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12418
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012419 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012420 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12421 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012422 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12423 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012424
12425 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12426
12427 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12428 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12429 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12430 inserted.
12431
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012432 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012433 - accept :
12434 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12435 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12436 the rules evaluation.
12437
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012438 - close :
12439 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12440 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12441 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12442 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12443 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12444 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012445 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012446 protocols.
12447
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012448 - reject :
12449 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12450 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012451 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012452
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012453 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12454 Sets a variable.
12455
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012456 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12457 Unsets a variable.
12458
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012459 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12460 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12461 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12462 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12463
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012464 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12465 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12466 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12467 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12468
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012469 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12470 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12471 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12472 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12473 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012474
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012475 - "silent-drop" :
12476 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012478 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12479 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12480 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12481 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12482 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012483 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12484 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012485 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12486 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012487 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012488 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12489 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12490 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12491 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12492
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012493 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12494 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12495
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012496 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12497 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12498 for changing the default action to a reject.
12499
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012500 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12501 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12502 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12503 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012504 period.
12505
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012506 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12507 declared inline.
12508
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012509 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12510 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012514 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012515 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012516 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012517 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12518 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012519 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012520 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12521 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012522
12523 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12524 followed by some converters.
12525
12526 Example:
12527
12528 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12529
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012530 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12531 <var-name>.
12532
12533 Example:
12534
12535 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12536
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012537 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12538 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12539 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12540 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12541 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12542
12543 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12544
12545 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12546
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012547 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12548
12549 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12550
12551
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012552tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12553 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12555 no | yes | yes | no
12556 Arguments :
12557 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12558 below.
12559
12560 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12561
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012562 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012563 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12564 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12565 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12566 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12567 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12568 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12569 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012570 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012571 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12572 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12573 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12574 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12575 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12576 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12577 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12578 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12579 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12580 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12581 instead.
12582
12583 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12584 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12585 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12586 rules which may be inserted.
12587
12588 Several types of actions are supported :
12589 - accept : the request is accepted
12590 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12591 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12592 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012593 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012594 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012595 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012596 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012597 - silent-drop
12598
12599 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12600 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12601 sections for a complete description.
12602
12603 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12604 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12605 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12606
12607 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12608 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12609 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12610 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12611 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12612
12613 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12614 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12615
12616 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12617 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12618 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12619
12620 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12621 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12622 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12623
12624 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12625 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12626 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12627
12628 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12629 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12630 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12631
12632 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12633
12634 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12635
12636
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012637tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12638 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12640 no | no | yes | yes
12641 Arguments :
12642 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12643 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12644 as explained at the top of this document.
12645
12646 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12647
12648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012649timeout check <timeout>
12650 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12651 established.
12652
12653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12654 yes | no | yes | yes
12655 Arguments:
12656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12658 as explained at the top of this document.
12659
12660 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12661 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012662 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012663 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012664 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12665 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12666 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012667
12668 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12669 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12670
12671 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12672 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012673 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012674
12675 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12676 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12677 forget about it.
12678
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012679 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12680 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012681
12682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012684 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12686 yes | yes | yes | no
12687 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12690 as explained at the top of this document.
12691
12692 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12693 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12694 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012695 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12696 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12697 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12698 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012699 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12700 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12701 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012702 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012703 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012704 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12705 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012706 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12707 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012708
12709 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12710 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12711 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12712 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012713 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012714 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12715
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012716 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012717
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012718 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012720
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012721timeout client-fin <timeout>
12722 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12724 yes | yes | yes | no
12725 Arguments :
12726 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12727 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12728 as explained at the top of this document.
12729
12730 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12731 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12732 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12733 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12734 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12735 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12736 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012737 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12738 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12739 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012740
12741 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12742 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12743 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12744
12745 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12746
12747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012748timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012749 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12751 yes | no | yes | yes
12752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012753 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012754 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12755 as explained at the top of this document.
12756
12757 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012758 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012759 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012760 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012761 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12762 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763
12764 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12766 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12767 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012768 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012769 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12770
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012771 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012773
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012774timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12775 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12777 yes | yes | yes | yes
12778 Arguments :
12779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12781 as explained at the top of this document.
12782
12783 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12784 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12785 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12786 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12787 once the request has started to present itself.
12788
12789 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12790 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12791 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12792 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12793 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12794
12795 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12796 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12797 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12798 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12799
12800 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12801 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012802 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012803 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12804 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012805 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012806
12807 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12808 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12809 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12810 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12811
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012812 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12813 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012814 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12815
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012816 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12817
12818
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012819timeout http-request <timeout>
12820 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012822 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12826 as explained at the top of this document.
12827
12828 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12829 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12830 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12831 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12832 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12833 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12834 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012835 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12836 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12837 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12838 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012840 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12841 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012842
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012843 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12844 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12845 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12846 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12847 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012848 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012849
12850 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12851 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012852 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012853 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12854 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12855
12856 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012857 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12858 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12859 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012860
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012861 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012862 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012863
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012864
12865timeout queue <timeout>
12866 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12868 yes | no | yes | yes
12869 Arguments :
12870 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12871 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12872 as explained at the top of this document.
12873
12874 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12875 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12876 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12877 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12878 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12879
12880 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12881 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12882 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12883 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12884
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012885 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012886
12887
12888timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012889 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12891 yes | no | yes | yes
12892 Arguments :
12893 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12894 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12895 as explained at the top of this document.
12896
12897 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12898 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12899 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12900 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12901 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12902 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12903 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12904
12905 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12906 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12907 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12908 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12909 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012910 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012911 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012912 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12913 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012914 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12915 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012916
12917 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12918 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12919 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12920 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012921 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012922 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12923
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012924 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012925
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012926
12927timeout server-fin <timeout>
12928 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12930 yes | no | yes | yes
12931 Arguments :
12932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12934 as explained at the top of this document.
12935
12936 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12937 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12938 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12939 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12940 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12941 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12942 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12943 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12944 situations, it should not be needed.
12945
12946 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12947 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12948 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12949
12950 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12951
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012952
12953timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012954 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12956 yes | yes | yes | yes
12957 Arguments :
12958 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12960 as explained at the top of this document.
12961
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012962 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12963 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12964 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012965
12966 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12967 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12968 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12969 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012970 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012971
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012972 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012973
12974
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012975timeout tunnel <timeout>
12976 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12978 yes | no | yes | yes
12979 Arguments :
12980 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12981 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12982 as explained at the top of this document.
12983
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012984 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012985 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12986 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12987 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12989 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012990 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12991 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12992 specified.
12993
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012994 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12995 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12996 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12997 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12998 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12999 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13000 state.
13001
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013002 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13003 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13004 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13005 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013006 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013007
13008 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13009 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13010 forget about it.
13011
13012 Example :
13013 defaults http
13014 option http-server-close
13015 timeout connect 5s
13016 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013017 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013018 timeout server 30s
13019 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13020
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013021 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013022
13023
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013024transparent (deprecated)
13025 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013027 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013028 Arguments : none
13029
13030 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13031 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13032 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13033 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13034 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13035 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13036 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13037 appropriate server.
13038
13039 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13040
13041 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13042 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13043
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013044 See also: "option transparent"
13045
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013046unique-id-format <string>
13047 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13049 yes | yes | yes | no
13050 Arguments :
13051 <string> is a log-format string.
13052
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013053 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13054 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13055 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13056 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013057
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013058 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13059 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13060 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13061 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13062 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13063 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13064 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13065 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013066
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013067 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13068 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013069
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013070 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013071
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013072 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013073
13074 will generate:
13075
13076 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13077
13078 See also: "unique-id-header"
13079
13080unique-id-header <name>
13081 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13083 yes | yes | yes | no
13084 Arguments :
13085 <name> is the name of the header.
13086
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013087 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13088 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013089
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013090 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013091
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013092 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013093 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13094
13095 will generate:
13096
13097 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13098
13099 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013100
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013101use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013102 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13104 no | yes | yes | no
13105 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013106 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13107 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013108
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013109 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13110 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013111
13112 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13113 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13114 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013115 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013116 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013117 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13118 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013119
13120 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13121 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13122 assign the backend.
13123
13124 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13125 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13126 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13127 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13128 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13129 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13130
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013131 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013132 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013133 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13134 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13135 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13136
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013137 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13138 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13139 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13140 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13141 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13142 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13143 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13144 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13145 cannot be forced from the request.
13146
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013147 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013148 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13149 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13150
13151 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13152 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013153
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013154use-fcgi-app <name>
13155 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13157 no | no | yes | yes
13158 Arguments :
13159 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13160
13161 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013162
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013163use-server <server> if <condition>
13164use-server <server> unless <condition>
13165 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13167 no | no | yes | yes
13168 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013169 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13170 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013171
13172 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13173
13174 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13175 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13176 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13177
13178 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13179 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13180 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13181 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13182 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13183 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13184 matches will assign the server.
13185
13186 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13187 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13188 with the next rules until one matches.
13189
13190 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13191 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13192 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13193 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13194
13195 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13196 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13197 stripped.
13198
13199 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13200 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013201 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13202 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13203 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013204
13205 Example :
13206 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13207 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13208 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13209 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013210 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013211 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013212 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013213 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13214 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13215
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013216 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13217 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13218 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13219 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013220 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013221 and we fall back to load balancing.
13222
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013223 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132265. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013227--------------------------
13228
13229The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13230depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13231settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13232written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13233described in this section.
13234
13235
132365.1. Bind options
13237-----------------
13238
13239The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13240as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13241no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13242parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13243while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13244provided immediately after the setting name.
13245
13246The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13247
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013248accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13249 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13250 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13251 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13252 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13253 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13254 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13255 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13256 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13257 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013258 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13259 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13260 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013261
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013262accept-proxy
13263 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013264 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13265 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013266 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13267 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13268 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13269 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013270 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013271 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13272 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013273 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13274 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013275
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013276allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013277 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013278 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013279 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013280 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13281 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013282
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013283alpn <protocols>
13284 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13285 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13286 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013287 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013288 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013289 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13290 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13291 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13292 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13293 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13294 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13295 preference, like below :
13296
13297 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013298
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013299backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013300 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013301 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13302
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013303curves <curves>
13304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13305 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13306 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13307 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13308 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13309 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13310
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013311ecdhe <named curve>
13312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013313 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13314 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013315
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013316ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13318 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13319 client's certificate.
13320
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013321ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13323 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13324 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13325 error is ignored.
13326
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013327ca-sign-file <cafile>
13328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13329 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13330 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13331 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13332 'generate-certificates' for details.
13333
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013334ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13336 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13337 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13338 'generate-certificates' for details.
13339
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013340ca-verify-file <cafile>
13341 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13342 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13343 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13344 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13345 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013347ciphers <ciphers>
13348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13349 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013350 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013351 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013352 information and recommendations see e.g.
13353 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13354 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13355 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13356
13357ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13359 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13360 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13361 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013362 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13363 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013364
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013365crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13367 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13368 to verify client's certificate.
13369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013370crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13372 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13373 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13374 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13375 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013376 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13377 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013378
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013379 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13380 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13381
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013382 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13383 are loaded.
13384
13385 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013386 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13387 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13388 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13389 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13390 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13391 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13392 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013393 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013394
13395 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13396 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13397 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13398 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013399 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13400 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013401
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013402 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013403
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013404 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013405 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013406 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13407 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013408 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13409 clients).
13410
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013411 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13412 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13413 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13414 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13415 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13416 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13417 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13418 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13419 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13420 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13421 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13422 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13423 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13424
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013425 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13426 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13427 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13428 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13429 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13430
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013431 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13432 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13433 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13434 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013435
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013436 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13437 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13438 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013439
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013440crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013442 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013443 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013444 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013445
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013446crt-list <file>
13447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013448 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13449 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013450
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013451 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13452
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013453 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13454 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13455 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13456 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13457 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013458
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013459 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013460 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13461 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13462 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13463 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13464 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013465 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13466 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13467 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013468
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013469 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13470 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13471 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013472
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013473 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13474
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013475 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13476 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13477 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13478 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13479 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13480 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13481 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13482 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013483
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013484 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013485 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013486 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013487 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013488 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013489 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013491defer-accept
13492 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13493 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13494 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013495 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013496 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13497 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13498 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13499 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13500 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13501 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13502 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13503
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013504expose-fd listeners
13505 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13506 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013507 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13508 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013509 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013510
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013511force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013512 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013513 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013514 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013515 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013516
13517force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013518 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013519 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013520 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013521
13522force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013523 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013524 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013525 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013526
13527force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013528 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013529 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013530 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013531
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013532force-tlsv13
13533 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13534 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013535 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013536
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013537generate-certificates
13538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13539 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13540 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13541 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13542 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13543 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13544 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13545 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13546 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13547 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13548 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13549
13550 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13551 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013552 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013553 certificate is used many times.
13554
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013555gid <gid>
13556 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13557 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13558 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13559 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13560 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13561
13562group <group>
13563 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13564 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13565 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13566 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13567 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13568
13569id <id>
13570 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13571 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13572 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13573 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13574
13575interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013576 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13577 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13578 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13579 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13580 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13581 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013582 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13583 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13584 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13585 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13586 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13587 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013588
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013589level <level>
13590 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13591 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13592 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013594 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13595 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13596 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013597 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013598 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013599 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013600 all counters).
13601
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013602severity-output <format>
13603 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13604 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13605 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13606 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13607 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13608 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13609 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13610 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13611 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13612 rfc5424 convention.
13613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013614maxconn <maxconn>
13615 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13616 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13617 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13618 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13619 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13620 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13621 eat all memory.
13622
13623mode <mode>
13624 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13625 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13626 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13627 UNIX sockets.
13628
13629mss <maxseg>
13630 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13631 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13632 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13633 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13634 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13635 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13636 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13637 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13638 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13639 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13640 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13641
13642name <name>
13643 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13644 page.
13645
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013646namespace <name>
13647 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13648 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13649 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13650 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013652nice <nice>
13653 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13654 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13655 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13656 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13657 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13658 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13659 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13660 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13661 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13662 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13663 one for an RDP socket.
13664
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013665no-ca-names
13666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13667 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013668 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013669
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013670no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013671 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013672 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013673 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013674 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013675 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13676 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013677
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013678no-tls-tickets
13679 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13680 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13681 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013682 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13683 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013684 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13685 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13686 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013687
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013688no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013690 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013691 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013692 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013693 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13694 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013695
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013696no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013698 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013699 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013700 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013701 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13702 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013703
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013704no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013706 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013707 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013708 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013709 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13710 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013711
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013712no-tlsv13
13713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13714 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13715 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13716 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013717 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13718 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013719
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013720npn <protocols>
13721 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13722 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13723 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013724 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013725 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013726 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13727 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13728 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13729 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13730 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013731
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013732prefer-client-ciphers
13733 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13734 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13735 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013736 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13737 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13738 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013739
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013740process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013741 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013742 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013743 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013744 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13745 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13746 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13747 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013749 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13750 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13751 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13752 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13753 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013754
13755 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13756
13757 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13758 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13759 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13760 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13761 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13762 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13763 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13764 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013765
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013766proto <name>
13767 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13768 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13769 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013770 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13771 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13772
13773 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13774 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13775 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13776 also reported (flag=HTX).
13777
13778 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13779 a bind line :
13780
13781 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13782 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13783 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13784
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013785 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013786 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013787 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013788 h2" on the bind line.
13789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013790ssl
13791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013792 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013793 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13794 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013795 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13796 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013797
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013798ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13799 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013800 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13801 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13802 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013803 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13804
13805ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013806 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13807 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13808 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13809 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013810
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013811strict-sni
13812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13813 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13814 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13815 See the "crt" option for more information.
13816
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013817tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013818 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013819 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13820 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013821 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013822 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13823 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13824 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13825 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13826 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13827 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13828 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13829
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013830tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013831 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013832 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13833 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13834 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13835 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13836 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13837 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13838 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013839 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13840 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13841 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013842
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013843tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13844 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013845 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13846 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13847 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13848 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13849 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13850 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13851 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13852 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13853 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13854 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013855 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13856 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13857
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013858transparent
13859 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13860 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13861 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13862 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13863 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13864 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13865 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13866 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13867 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13868 so check for support with your vendor.
13869
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013870v4v6
13871 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13872 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13873 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13874 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013875 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013876
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013877v6only
13878 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13879 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13880 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013881 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13882 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013884uid <uid>
13885 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13886 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13887 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13888 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13889 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13890
13891user <user>
13892 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13893 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13894 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13895 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13896 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13897
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013898verify [none|optional|required]
13899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13900 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13901 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13902 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13903 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013904 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13905 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13906 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13907 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013908
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139095.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013910------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013912The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13913which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13914arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13915settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13916after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13917Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13918address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013920 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013921 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013922
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013923Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13924keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013926The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013927
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013928addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013929 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013930 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13931 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13932 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13933 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13934 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013935
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013936agent-check
13937 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013938 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013939 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13940 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13941 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013942
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013943 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013944 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013945 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13946 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13947 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013949 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13950 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13951 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13952 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13953 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013954
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013955 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013957
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013958 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13959 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13960 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013961
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013962 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13963 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13964 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013965
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013966 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013967 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13968 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13969 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13970 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013971 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013972 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013973
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013974 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13975 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013976
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013977 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13978 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13979 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13980 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13981 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13982 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13983 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13984 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13985 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013986
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013987 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13988 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013989 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13990 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13991 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013992 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013993
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013994 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013995 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013996
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013997agent-send <string>
13998 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13999 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14000 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14001 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14002 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14003
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014004agent-inter <delay>
14005 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14006 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14007
14008 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14009 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14010 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14011 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14012 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14013 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14014 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14015 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14016 of backends use the same servers.
14017
14018 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14019
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014020agent-addr <addr>
14021 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14022
14023 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
14024 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
14025 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14026 hostname, it will be resolved.
14027
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014028agent-port <port>
14029 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14030
14031 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14032
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014033allow-0rtt
14034 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014035 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14036 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014037
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014038alpn <protocols>
14039 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14040 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14041 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014042 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014043 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14044 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14045 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14046 now obsolete NPN extension.
14047 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14048 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14049
14050 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014052backup
14053 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14054 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14055 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14056 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014057 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14058 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014059
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014060ca-file <cafile>
14061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14062 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14063 server's certificate.
14064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014065check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014066 This option enables health checks on a server:
14067 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14068 considered available.
14069 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14070 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14071 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14072 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14073 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14074 set.
14075 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14076 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14077 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14078 exchanges succeed.
14079
14080 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14081 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14082 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14083 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14084 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014085 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014086 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14087
14088 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14089 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14090
14091 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14092 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14093
14094 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14095 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14096 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14097 available.
14098
14099 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14100 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14101 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14102
14103 Example:
14104 # simple tcp check
14105 backend foo
14106 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14107 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14108 backend foo
14109 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14110 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14111 backend foo
14112 option tcp-check
14113 tcp-check connect
14114 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014115
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014116check-send-proxy
14117 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14118 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14119 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14120 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14121 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14122 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14123 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14124
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014125check-alpn <protocols>
14126 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14127 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14128 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14129
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014130check-proto <name>
14131 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14132 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14133 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014134 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14135 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14136
14137 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14138 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14139 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14140 also reported (flag=HTX).
14141
14142 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14143 directive on a server line:
14144
14145 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14146 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14147 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14148 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14149
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014150 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014151 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14152 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14153
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014154check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014155 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014156 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14157 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014158
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014159check-ssl
14160 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14161 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14162 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14163 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014164 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014165 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14166 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014167 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014168 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14169 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014170
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014171check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014172 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014173 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14174 for normal traffic.
14175
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014176ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14178 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14179 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014180 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14181 information and recommendations see e.g.
14182 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14183 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14184 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014185
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014186ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14188 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14189 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14190 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014191 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14192 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14193 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014195cookie <value>
14196 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14197 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14198 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14199 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14200 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14201 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14202 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14203
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014204crl-file <crlfile>
14205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14206 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14207 to verify server's certificate.
14208
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014209crt <cert>
14210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14211 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14212 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14213 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14214 certificate request.
14215
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014216disabled
14217 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14218 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14219 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14220 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14221 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014222 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014223
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014224enabled
14225 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14226 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14227 default value.
14228 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14229 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014231error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014232 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14233 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14234 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014236 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014238fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014239 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14240 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14241 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14242
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014243force-sslv3
14244 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14245 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014246 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014247 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014248
14249force-tlsv10
14250 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014251 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014252 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014253
14254force-tlsv11
14255 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014256 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014257 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014258
14259force-tlsv12
14260 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014261 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014262 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014263
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014264force-tlsv13
14265 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14266 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014267 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014269id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014270 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14271 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14272 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014273
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014274init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14275 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14276 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014277 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014278 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14279 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14280 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14281 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14282 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14283 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14284 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14285 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14286 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014287 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014288 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14289 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14290 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14291 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14292 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14293 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014294 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014295
14296 Example:
14297 defaults
14298 # never fail on address resolution
14299 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014301inter <delay>
14302fastinter <delay>
14303downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014304 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14305 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14306 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14307 between checks depending on the server state :
14308
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014309 Server state | Interval used
14310 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14311 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14312 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14313 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14314 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14315 or yet unchecked. |
14316 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14317 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14318 | "inter" otherwise.
14319 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014321 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14322 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14323 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14324 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014325 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14326 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14327 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14328 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14329 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014330
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014331log-proto <logproto>
14332 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14333 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14334 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14335 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014337maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014338 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14339 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014340 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14341 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014342 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14343 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14344 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14345 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14346
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014347 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14348 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14349 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14350 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14351 than 50 concurrent requests.
14352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014353maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014354 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14355 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14356 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14357 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014358 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14359 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14360 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14361 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14362 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14363 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14364 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014365
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014366max-reuse <count>
14367 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14368 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14369 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14370 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14371 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14372 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14373 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14374 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014376minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014377 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14378 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14379 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14380 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14381 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14382 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014383 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014384 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014385
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014386namespace <name>
14387 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14388 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14389 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14390 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14391
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014392no-agent-check
14393 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14394 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14395 default value.
14396 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14397 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14398
14399no-backup
14400 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14401 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14402 default value.
14403 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14404 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14405
14406no-check
14407 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14408 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14409 default value.
14410 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14411 "default-server" "check" setting.
14412
14413no-check-ssl
14414 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14415 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14416 default value.
14417 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14418 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14419
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014420no-send-proxy
14421 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14422 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14423 default value.
14424 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14425 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14426
14427no-send-proxy-v2
14428 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14429 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14430 default value.
14431 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14432 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14433
14434no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14435 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14436 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14437 default value.
14438 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14439 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14440
14441no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14442 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14443 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14444 default value.
14445 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14446 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14447
14448no-ssl
14449 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14450 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14451 default value.
14452 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14453 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14454
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014455 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14456 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14457 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14458
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014459no-ssl-reuse
14460 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14461 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14462 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14463 and for paranoid users.
14464
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014465no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014466 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14467 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014468 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014469
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014470 Supported in default-server: No
14471
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014472no-tls-tickets
14473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14474 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14475 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014476 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14477 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014478 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14479 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14480 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014481 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014482
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014483no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014484 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014485 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14486 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014487 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14488 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014489 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014490
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014491 Supported in default-server: No
14492
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014493no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014494 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014495 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14496 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014497 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14498 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014499 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014500
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014501 Supported in default-server: No
14502
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014503no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014504 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014505 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14506 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014507 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14508 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014509 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014510
14511 Supported in default-server: No
14512
14513no-tlsv13
14514 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14515 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14516 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14517 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14518 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014519 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014520
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014521 Supported in default-server: No
14522
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014523no-verifyhost
14524 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14525 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14526 default value.
14527 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14528 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014529
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014530no-tfo
14531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14533 default value.
14534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14535 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14536
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014537non-stick
14538 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14539 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14540 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14541
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014542npn <protocols>
14543 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14544 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14545 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014546 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014547 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14548 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14549 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014551observe <mode>
14552 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14553 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14554 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14555 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14556 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14557 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014558 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014559
14560 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014562on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014563 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14564 Currently, four modes are available:
14565 - fastinter: force fastinter
14566 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14567 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14568 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14569 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14570
14571 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14572
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014573on-marked-down <action>
14574 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14575 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014576 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14577 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14578 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14579 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14580 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14581 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14582 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14583 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014584
14585 Actions are disabled by default
14586
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014587on-marked-up <action>
14588 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14589 Currently one action is available:
14590 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14591 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14592 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14593 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014594 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14595 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014596 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14597 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14598
14599 Actions are disabled by default
14600
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014601pool-low-conn <max>
14602 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14603 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14604 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14605 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14606 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14607 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14608 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14609 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14610 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14611 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014612 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14613 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14614 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14615 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014616
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014617pool-max-conn <max>
14618 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14619 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14620 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14621 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14622 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14623 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14624
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014625pool-purge-delay <delay>
14626 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014627 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014628 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014630port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014631 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014632 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14633 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14634 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14635 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14636 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014637
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014638proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014639 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14640 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14641 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014642 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14643 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14644
14645 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14646 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14647 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14648 also reported (flag=HTX).
14649
14650 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14651 a server line :
14652
14653 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14654 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14655 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14656 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14657
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014658 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014659 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014661redir <prefix>
14662 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14663 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14664 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14665 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14666 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14667 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14668 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14669 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014670 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014671 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014672 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14673 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14674 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14675 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14676
14677 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014679rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014680 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14681 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14682 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14683
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014684resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14685 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14686 server.
14687
14688 Available options:
14689
14690 * allow-dup-ip
14691 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14692 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14693 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14694 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14695 For such case, simply enable this option.
14696 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14697
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014698 * ignore-weight
14699 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14700 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14701 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14702
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014703 * prevent-dup-ip
14704 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14705 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14706 same fqdn.
14707 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14708
14709 Example:
14710 backend b_myapp
14711 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14712 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14713 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14714
14715 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14716 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14717 it
14718 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14719 different address
14720
14721 Default value: not set
14722
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014723resolve-prefer <family>
14724 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14725 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14726 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14727 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14728
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014729 Default value: ipv6
14730
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014731 Example:
14732
14733 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014734
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014735resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014736 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014737 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014738 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014739 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14740 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014741 configured network, another address is selected.
14742
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014743 Example:
14744
14745 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014746
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014747resolvers <id>
14748 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14749 hostname.
14750
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014751 Example:
14752
14753 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014754
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014755 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014756
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014757send-proxy
14758 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14759 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14760 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14761 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014762 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14763 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14764 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14765 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14766 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14767 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14768 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14769 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14770 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14771 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014772 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14773 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014774
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014775send-proxy-v2
14776 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14777 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14778 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14779 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014780 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14781 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14782 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14783 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014784
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014785proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014786 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14787 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14788
14789 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14790 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14791 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14792 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14793 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14794 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14795 connection is supported).
14796 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14797 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14798 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14799 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14800 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14801 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14802 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014803
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014804send-proxy-v2-ssl
14805 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14806 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14807 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14808 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14809 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14810 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14811 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014812 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14813 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014814
14815send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14816 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14817 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14818 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14819 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14820 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14821 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14822 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14823 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014824 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14825 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014827slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014828 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14829 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14830 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14831 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14832 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14833 parameters :
14834
14835 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14836 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14837
14838 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14839 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14840 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14841 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14842
14843 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14844 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14845 seen as failed.
14846
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014847sni <expression>
14848 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14849 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14850 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14851 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014852 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14853 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014854 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014855 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14856 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014857
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014858source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014859source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014860source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014861 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14862 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14863 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14864 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14865
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014866 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14867 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14868 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14869 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14870 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14871 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14872 server.
14873
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014874 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14875 specifying the source address without port(s).
14876
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014877ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014878 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14879 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14880 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14881 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14882 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14883 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014884 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14885 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014886
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014887ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14888 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14889 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14890 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14891
14892ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14893 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14894 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14895 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14896
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014897ssl-reuse
14898 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14899 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14900 default value.
14901 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14902 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14903
14904stick
14905 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14906 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14907 default value.
14908 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14909 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014910
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014911socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014912 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014913 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14914 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14915
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014916tcp-ut <delay>
14917 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14918 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14919 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014920 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014921 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14922 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14923 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14924 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14925 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14926 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14927 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14928 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14929 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14930
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014931tfo
14932 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14933 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14934 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14935 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14936 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014937 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014939track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014940 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14941 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14942 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14943 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014944 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14945
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014946tls-tickets
14947 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14948 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14949 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014950 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14951 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14952 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014953 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014954 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014955
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014956verify [none|required]
14957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014958 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014959 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14960 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014962 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14963 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14964 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14965 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14966 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14967 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14968 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14969 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014970
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014971verifyhost <hostname>
14972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014973 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14974 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14975 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14976 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14977 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14978 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14979 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14980 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014982weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014983 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14984 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14985 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014986 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14987 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14988 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14989 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14990 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14991 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014992
14993
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14995-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014996
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014997HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14998using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014999configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015000This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15001can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15002workload.
15003This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15004resolution at run time.
15005Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15006carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15007
15008
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150095.3.1. Global overview
15010----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015011
15012As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15013different steps of the process life:
15014
15015 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15016 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15017 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15018
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015019 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15020 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015021
15022A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15023 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15024 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15025 resolution to know this new IP.
15026
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015027When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015028HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015029SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15030from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
15031will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
15032will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015033
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015034A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015035 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015036 first valid response.
15037
15038 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15039 servers return an error.
15040
15041
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150425.3.2. The resolvers section
15043----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015044
15045This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015046HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15047contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015048
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015049When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15050uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15051is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15052answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15053
15054When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015055used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015056
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015057 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15058 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15059 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015060
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015061 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15062 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015063
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015064 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15065 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15066 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015067
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015068For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15069following scenarios are possible:
15070
15071 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15072 ignored
15073
15074 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15075 applied
15076
15077 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15078 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15079
15080 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15081 retries the query with a new type
15082
15083 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15084 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015085
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015086As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15087a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015088<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015089
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015090
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015091resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015092 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015093
15094A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15095
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015096accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015097 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015098 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015099 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15100 by RFC 6891)
15101
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015102 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15103 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15104 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15105 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15106 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15107 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015108
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015109nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15110 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15111 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15112 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15113 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15114 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15115 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15116 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15117 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15118 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015119 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15120
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015121parse-resolv-conf
15122 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15123 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15124 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15125
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015126hold <status> <period>
15127 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15128 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015129 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015130 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015131 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15132 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15133 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15134
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015135 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015136
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015137resolve_retries <nb>
15138 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15139 giving up.
15140 Default value: 3
15141
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015142 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15143 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15144 type.
15145
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015146timeout <event> <time>
15147 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15148 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15149 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015150 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15151 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015152 Default value: 1s
15153 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015154 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015155 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015156 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15157 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15158
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015159 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015160
15161 resolvers mydns
15162 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15163 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015164 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015165 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015166 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015167 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015168 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015169 hold other 30s
15170 hold refused 30s
15171 hold nx 30s
15172 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015173 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015174 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015175
15176
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151776. Cache
15178---------
15179
15180HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15181(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15182RAM.
15183
15184The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15185this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15186
15187If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15188independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15189when we try to allocate a new one.
15190
15191The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15192
15193It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15194"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15195for more details.
15196
15197When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15198replaced by "<CACHE>".
15199
15200
152016.1. Limitation
15202----------------
15203
15204The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15205
15206- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015207- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15208 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15209 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015210- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15211- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015212- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15213 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15214 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015215- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15216 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015217- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15218 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15219 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015220
15221- If the request is not a GET
15222- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15223- If the request contains an Authorization header
15224
15225
152266.2. Setup
15227-----------
15228
15229To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15230the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15231
15232
152336.2.1. Cache section
15234---------------------
15235
15236cache <name>
15237 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15238 size of cache is mandatory.
15239
15240total-max-size <megabytes>
15241 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15242 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15243
15244max-object-size <bytes>
15245 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15246 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15247 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15248
15249max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015250 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015251 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15252 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15253 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15254 default.
15255
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015256process-vary <on/off>
15257 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015258 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15259 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15260 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015261 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015262
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015263max-secondary-entries <number>
15264 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15265 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15266 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15267
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015268
152696.2.2. Proxy section
15270---------------------
15271
15272http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15273 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15274 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15275 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15276 after this one.
15277
15278http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15279 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15280 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15281 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15282 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15283
15284
15285Example:
15286
15287 backend bck1
15288 mode http
15289
15290 http-request cache-use foobar
15291 http-response cache-store foobar
15292 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15293
15294 cache foobar
15295 total-max-size 4
15296 max-age 240
15297
15298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152997. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15300----------------------------------
15301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015302HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15304The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15305these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15306but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15307data called patterns.
15308
15309
153107.1. ACL basics
15311---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015312
15313The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15314content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15315from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15316simple :
15317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015319 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15321 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15324adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015325
15326In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015328 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015329
15330This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15331Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15332and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015333an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15334conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15335as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15336are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015337
15338ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15339'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15340which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15341
15342There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15343performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15346specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15347this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015348methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15349ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350
15351Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15352 - boolean
15353 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15354 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15355 - string
15356 - data block
15357
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015358Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15359converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15360would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15361The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15362which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15363
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015364Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15365keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15366fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15367which are summarized in the table below :
15368
15369 +---------------------+-----------------+
15370 | Sample or converter | Default |
15371 | output type | matching method |
15372 +---------------------+-----------------+
15373 | boolean | bool |
15374 +---------------------+-----------------+
15375 | integer | int |
15376 +---------------------+-----------------+
15377 | ip | ip |
15378 +---------------------+-----------------+
15379 | string | str |
15380 +---------------------+-----------------+
15381 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15382 +---------------------+-----------------+
15383
15384Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15385matching method, see below.
15386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15388 - boolean
15389 - integer or integer range
15390 - IP address / network
15391 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15392 - regular expression
15393 - hex block
15394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015395The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15396
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015397 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15398 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015400 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015401 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015402 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015403 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15406read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15407if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15408lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15409will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15410beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15411a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15412lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15413exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15414
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015415The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15416parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15417ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15418a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15419check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15420
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015421The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15422socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15423file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15426loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15427
15428 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15429
15430In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15431the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15432case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15433as well.
15434
15435The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15436sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15437do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15438methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15439is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015440obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15442default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15443that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15444string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15445
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015446The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15447By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15448string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15449resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15450server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015451waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015452flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15453function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15456sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15457be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015458
15459 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15460 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15462 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15463 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15464 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015465
15466 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15467 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015469
15470 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015472
15473 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015476 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015477 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15478
15479 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15480 binary or string samples.
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15483 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15486 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15487 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15490 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15493 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15496 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15499 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015500 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15503 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15504 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015505
15506For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15507request, it is possible to do :
15508
15509 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15510
15511In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15512buffer, one would use the following acl :
15513
15514 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15515
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015516On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15517possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15518
15519 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15522criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15523method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15524to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15525criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15526the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015529the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15530For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15533 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15534 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15535 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015536
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015537
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015538The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15539types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15540combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15541brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15542default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 +-------------------------------------------------+
15545 | Input sample type |
15546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015547 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15549 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015551 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015553 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015555 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015557 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015559 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015561 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015563 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015565 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015567 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015569 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015571 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15573 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015575
15576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155777.1.1. Matching booleans
15578------------------------
15579
15580In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15581Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15582When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15583that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15584
15585Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15586return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15587"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15588
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155907.1.2. Matching integers
15591------------------------
15592
15593Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15594enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15595to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15596
15597Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15598matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15599lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015600
15601For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15602unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15603representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15604
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015605As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15606two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15607instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15608ranges and operators.
15609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015610For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015611operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15612Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15613of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015615Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015616
15617 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15618 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15619 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15620 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15621 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015623For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015624
15625 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15626
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015627This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15628
15629 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156327.1.3. Matching strings
15633-----------------------
15634
15635String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15636different forms :
15637
15638 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015639 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640
15641 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643
15644 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15645 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15646
15647 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15648 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15649
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015650 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15652 matches.
15653
15654 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15655 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15656 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015657
15658String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15659exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15660characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15661string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15662to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015663before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015664
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015665Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15666(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15667Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15668
15669Example:
15670 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15671 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15675---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015676
15677Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15678they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15679possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15680passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15681the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015682the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15683match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015684
15685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156867.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15687-------------------------------------
15688
15689It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15690not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15691a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15692to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15693digits may be used upper or lower case.
15694
15695Example :
15696 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15697 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15698
15699
157007.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15701---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015702
15703IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15704netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15705within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015706host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015707difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15708at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15709does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15710parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015711
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015712The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15713abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15714
15715 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15716 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15717 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15718 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15719 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15720 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15721 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15722 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15723
15724Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15725192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15726
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015727IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15728Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15729trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15730IPv6 patterns.
15731
15732HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15733following situations :
15734 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15735 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15736 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15737 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15738 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15739 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15740 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15741 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15742 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15743 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745
157467.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15747----------------------------------
15748
15749Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15750combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15751
15752 - AND (implicit)
15753 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15754 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15761indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15764"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15765requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15766is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15767
15768 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015769 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15770 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15771 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772
15773To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15774and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15775
15776 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15777 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15778 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15779 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015781 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15783 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15784 use_backend www if host_www
15785
15786It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15787expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15788be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15789the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15790
15791 The following rule :
15792
15793 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015794 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795
15796 Can also be written that way :
15797
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015798 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799
15800It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15801to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15802simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15803sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15804good use is the following :
15805
15806 With named ACLs :
15807
15808 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15809 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15810 monitor fail if site_dead
15811
15812 With anonymous ACLs :
15813
15814 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15815
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015816See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15817keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818
15819
158207.3. Fetching samples
15821---------------------
15822
15823Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15824against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15825sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15826ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15827of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15828available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15829
15830This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15831Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15832compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15833deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15834
15835The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15836matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15837method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15838indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15839
15840As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15841when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15842mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15843the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15844ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15845
15846Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15847multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15848when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015849incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15850are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15852all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15853
15854Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15855 - name
15856 - name(arg1)
15857 - name(arg1,arg2)
15858
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015859
158607.3.1. Converters
15861-----------------
15862
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015863Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15864of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15865is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15866was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015867has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015868unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15869
15870These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15871sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15872the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015873support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015874
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015875A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15876support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15877supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15878(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15879bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015882
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001588351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15884 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15885 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15886 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15887 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15888 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15889
15890 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15892 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015893 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15894 frontend http-in
15895 bind *:8081
15896 default_backend servers
15897 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15898 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15899
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015900add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015901 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015902 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015903 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15904 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15907 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15908 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15909 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015910 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015911 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015912
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015913aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15914 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15915 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15916 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15917 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15918 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15919 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15920
15921 Example:
15922 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15923 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15924
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015925and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015926 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015927 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015928 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15929 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015937
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015938b64dec
15939 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15940 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015941 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15942 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015943
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015944base64
15945 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015946 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015947 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15948 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015949
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015950bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015951 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015952 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015953 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015954 presence of a flag).
15955
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015956bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15957 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15958 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015959 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015960
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015961concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15962 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15963 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15964 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15965 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15966 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15967 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15968 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15969 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15970 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15971 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015972 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015973 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015974 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15975 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015976
15977 Example:
15978 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15979 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15980 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015981 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015982 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15983
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015984cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015985 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15986 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015987
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015988crc32([<avalanche>])
15989 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15990 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15991 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15992 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15993 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15994 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15995 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15996 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15997 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15998 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015999 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16000
16001crc32c([<avalanche>])
16002 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16003 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16004 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16005 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16006 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16007 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16008 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16009 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016010
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016011cut_crlf
16012 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16013 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16014 updated.
16015
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016016da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016017 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16018 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16019 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16020 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016021 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016022 configuration language.
16023
16024 Example:
16025 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016026 bind *:8881
16027 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016028 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016029
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016030debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16031 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16032 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16033 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16034 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16035 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16036 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16037 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16038 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16039 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16040 printable sample types.
16041
16042 Example:
16043 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016044
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016045digest(<algorithm>)
16046 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16047 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16048
16049 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16050 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16051
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016052div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016053 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16054 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016055 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016056 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16057 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016058 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016059 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16060 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16061 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16062 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016064 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016065
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016066djb2([<avalanche>])
16067 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16068 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16069 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16070 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16071 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16072 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16073 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016074 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16075 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016076
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016077even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016078 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016079 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16080
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016081field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16082 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16083 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16084 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16085 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16086 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16087 fields.
16088
16089 Example :
16090 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16091 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16092 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16093 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16094 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016095
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016096fix_is_valid
16097 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16098 Information eXchange):
16099
16100 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16101 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016102 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016103 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016104 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016105 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16106 checksum
16107
16108 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16109 the server can be parsed.
16110
16111 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16112 message, false if not.
16113
16114 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16115
16116 Example:
16117 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16118 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16119
16120fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16121 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16122 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16123 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16124 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016125 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016126 added.
16127
16128 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16129 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16130 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16131 fix_is_valid converter.
16132
16133 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16134
16135 Example:
16136 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16137 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16138 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16139 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16140 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016142hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016143 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016144 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016146 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016147
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016148hex2i
16149 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016150 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016151
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016152htonl
16153 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16154 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16155 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16156 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16157
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016158hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016159 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16160 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16161 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16162 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16163
16164 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16165 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16166
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016167http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016168 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16169 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016170 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16171 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16172 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16173 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16174 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16175 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16176 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16177 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016179iif(<true>,<false>)
16180 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16181 string otherwise.
16182
16183 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016184 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016185
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016186in_table(<table>)
16187 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16188 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16189 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016190 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016191 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16192
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016193ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016194 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016195 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016196 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16197 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16198 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16199 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16200 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016201
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016202json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016203 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016204 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016205 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016206 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16207 of errors:
16208 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16209 bytes, ...)
16210 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16211 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16212
16213 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16214 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16215 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16216 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16217 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16218 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016219 - "ascii" : never fails;
16220 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16221 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016222 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016223 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016224 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16225 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16226
16227 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016228 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016229
16230 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016231 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016232 capture request header user-agent len 150
16233 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016234
16235 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16236 GET / HTTP/1.0
16237 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16238
16239 Output log:
16240 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16241
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016242json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16243 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16244 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16245 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16246 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16247
16248 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16249 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16250
16251 Example:
16252 # get a integer value from the request body
16253 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16254 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16255
16256 # get a key with '.' in the name
16257 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16258 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16259
16260 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16261 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16262
16263 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16264 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016266language(<value>[,<default>])
16267 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16268 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16269 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16270 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16271 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16272 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16273 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16274 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16275 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016276 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016277 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16278 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016279
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016280 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016281
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016282 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16283 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016284
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016285 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16286 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16287 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16288 use_backend spanish if es
16289 use_backend french if fr
16290 use_backend english if en
16291 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016292
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016293length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016294 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16295 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16296 type. The result is of type integer.
16297
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016298lower
16299 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16300 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16301 type. The result is of type string.
16302
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016303ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16304 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16305 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16306 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16307 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16308 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16309 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16310
16311 Example :
16312
16313 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016314 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016315 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16316
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016317ltrim(<chars>)
16318 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16319 representation of the input sample.
16320
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016321map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16322map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16323map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16324 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16325 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16326 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16327 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16328 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16329 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16330 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16331 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016332
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016333 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16334 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16335 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016336
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016337 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016338 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016339
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016340 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16341 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16342 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16343 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016344 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16345 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016346 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16347 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16348 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16349 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16350 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16351 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16352 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16353 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016354 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16355 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16356 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016357 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16358 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16359 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16360 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16361 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016362
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016363 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16364 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16365 the corresponding match text.
16366
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016367 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16368 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16369 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16370 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16371 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016372
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016373 Example :
16374
16375 # this is a comment and is ignored
16376 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16377 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16378 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16379 | | | `---------- value
16380 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16381 | `---------------------------- key
16382 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16383
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016384mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016385 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16386 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016387 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016388 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16391 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16392 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16393 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016394 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016395 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016396
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016397mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016398 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16399 <packettype>.
16400 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16401 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16402 from.
16403 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16404 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16405 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16406
16407 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16408 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16409 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16410 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16411
16412 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16413 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16414 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16415 packets only):
16416 17: Session Expiry Interval
16417 33: Receive Maximum
16418 39: Maximum Packet Size
16419 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16420 25: Request Response Information
16421 23: Request Problem Information
16422 21: Authentication Method
16423 22: Authentication Data
16424 18: Will Delay Interval
16425 1: Payload Format Indicator
16426 2: Message Expiry Interval
16427 3: Content Type
16428 8: Response Topic
16429 9: Correlation Data
16430 Not supported yet:
16431 38: User Property
16432
16433 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16434 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16435 packets only):
16436 17: Session Expiry Interval
16437 33: Receive Maximum
16438 36: Maximum QoS
16439 37: Retain Available
16440 39: Maximum Packet Size
16441 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16442 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16443 31: Reason String
16444 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16445 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16446 42: Shared Subscription Available
16447 19: Server Keep Alive
16448 26: Response Information
16449 28: Server Reference
16450 21: Authentication Method
16451 22: Authentication Data
16452 Not supported yet:
16453 38: User Property
16454
16455 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16456 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16457 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16458 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16459
16460 Example:
16461
16462 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16463 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16464 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16465 if data_in_buffer
16466 # do the same as above
16467 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16468 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16469 if data_in_buffer
16470
16471mqtt_is_valid
16472 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16473
16474 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16475 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16476 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16477 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16478
16479 Example:
16480
16481 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16482 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16483
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016484mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016485 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016486 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16487 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016488 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016489 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016490 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016491 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16492 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16493 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16494 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016495 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016496 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016497
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016498nbsrv
16499 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16500 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16501 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16502 map lookup.
16503
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016504neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016505 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16506 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16507 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16508 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016509
16510not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016511 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016512 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016513 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016514 absence of a flag).
16515
16516odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016517 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016518 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16519
16520or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016521 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016522 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016523 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16524 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016525 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016526 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16527 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16528 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016530 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016531 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016532
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016533protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16534 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16535 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16536 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16537 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16538 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16539 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16540 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16541 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16542 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16543 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16544 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16545
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016546regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016547 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16548 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16549 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16550 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16551 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16552 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16553 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16554 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16555 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016556 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16557 of characters with other ones.
16558
16559 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16560 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16561 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16562 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16563 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16564 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016565
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016566 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016567
16568 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16569 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16570 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016571 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016572
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016573 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16574 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16575
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016576 # capture groups and backreferences
16577 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016578 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016579 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16580
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016581capture-req(<id>)
16582 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16583 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16584
16585 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016586 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16587 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016588
16589capture-res(<id>)
16590 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16591 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16592
16593 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016594 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16595 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016596
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016597rtrim(<chars>)
16598 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16599 of the input sample.
16600
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016601sdbm([<avalanche>])
16602 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16603 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16604 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16605 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16606 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16607 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16608 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016609 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16610 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016611
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016612secure_memcmp(<var>)
16613 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16614 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16615 match.
16616
16617 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16618 performed in constant time.
16619
16620 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16621 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16622
16623 Example :
16624
16625 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16626 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16627 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16628 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16629
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016630set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016631 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16632 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16633 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016634 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016635 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16636 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016637 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016638 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16639 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016641 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016642
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016643sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016644 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016645 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16646
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016647sha2([<bits>])
16648 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16649 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16650
16651 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16652 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16653
16654 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16655 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16656
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016657srv_queue
16658 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16659 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16660 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16661 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16662 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16663
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016664strcmp(<var>)
16665 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16666 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16667 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16668 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16669 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16670 shorter).
16671
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016672 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16673 strings in constant time.
16674
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016675 Example :
16676
16677 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16678 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16679 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16680
16681
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016682sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016683 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16684 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016685 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016686 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16687 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016688 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16690 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016691 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016696
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016697table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16698 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16699 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16700 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16701 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16702 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16703 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16704
16705
16706table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16710 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16711 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16712 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16713
16714table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016717 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016718 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16719 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16720
16721table_conn_cur(<table>)
16722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16725 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16726 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16727
16728table_conn_rate(<table>)
16729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16732 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16733 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16734
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016735table_gpt0(<table>)
16736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16739 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16740 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16741
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016742table_gpc0(<table>)
16743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16746 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16747 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16748
16749table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16753 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16754 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16755 sample fetch keyword.
16756
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016757table_gpc1(<table>)
16758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16761 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16762 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16763
16764table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16765 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16766 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16767 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16768 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16769 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16770 sample fetch keyword.
16771
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016772table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016776 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16777 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16778
16779table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16782 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16783 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16784 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16785 keyword.
16786
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016787table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16791 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16792 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16793
16794table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16797 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16798 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16799 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16800 keyword.
16801
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016802table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16803 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16804 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016805 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016806 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16807 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16808
16809table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16812 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16813 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16814 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16815 keyword.
16816
16817table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016821 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16822 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16823 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16824 keyword.
16825
16826table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016830 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16831 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16832 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16833 keyword.
16834
16835table_server_id(<table>)
16836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16839 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16840 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16841 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16842
16843table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016846 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016847 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16848 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16849 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16850 keyword.
16851
16852table_sess_rate(<table>)
16853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16856 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16857 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16858 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16859 keyword.
16860
16861table_trackers(<table>)
16862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16865 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16866 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16867 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16868 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16869 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16870 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16871 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16872
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016873ub64dec
16874 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16875 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16876 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16877
16878 Example:
16879 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16880 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16881
16882ub64enc
16883 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16884
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016885upper
16886 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16887 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16888 type. The result is of type string.
16889
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016890url_dec([<in_form>])
16891 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16892 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16893 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16894 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16895 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16896 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016897
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016898url_enc([<enc_type>])
16899 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16900 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16901 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16902 optional argument is here for future changes.
16903
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016904ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016905 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016906 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16907 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16908 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016909 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16910 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16911 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16912 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016913 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016914 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16915 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016916
16917 Example:
16918 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16919 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16920
16921 message Point {
16922 int32 latitude = 1;
16923 int32 longitude = 2;
16924 }
16925
16926 message PPoint {
16927 Point point = 59;
16928 }
16929
16930 message Rectangle {
16931 // One corner of the rectangle.
16932 PPoint lo = 48;
16933 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16934 PPoint hi = 49;
16935 }
16936
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016937 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16938 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16939 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016940
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016941 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16942 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016943 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016944 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16945
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016946 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016947
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016948 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016949
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016950 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16951 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16952 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016953
16954 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16955 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16956 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16957
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016958 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16959 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16960 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016961
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016962
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016963unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016964 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16965 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16966 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16967 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16968 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16969 response),
16970 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16971 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16973 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16974
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016975utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16976 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16977 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16978 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16979 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16980 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16981 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16982
16983 Example :
16984
16985 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016986 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016987 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16988
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016989word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16990 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16991 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16992 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016993 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016994 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16995 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16996
16997 Example :
16998 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16999 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17000 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17001 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17002 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017003 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017004
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017005wt6([<avalanche>])
17006 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17007 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17008 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17009 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17010 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17011 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17012 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017013 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17014 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017015
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017016xor(<value>)
17017 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017018 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017019 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017020 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17023 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017024 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017025 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17026 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017027 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017028 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017029
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017030xxh3([<seed>])
17031 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17032 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17033 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17034 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17035 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17036 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17037 considered as cryptographically secure.
17038
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017039xxh32([<seed>])
17040 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17041 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17042 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17043 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17044 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17045 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17046 as cryptographically secure.
17047
17048xxh64([<seed>])
17049 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17050 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17051 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17052 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17053 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17054 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17055 as cryptographically secure.
17056
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170587.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059--------------------------------------------
17060
17061A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17062not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17063"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17064The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17065
17066always_false : boolean
17067 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17068 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17069
17070always_true : boolean
17071 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17072 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17073
17074avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017075 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017076 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17077 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17078 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17079 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17080 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17081 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17082 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17083 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17084 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17085 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17086 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17087 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17088 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017091 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17092 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17093 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17094 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017095 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17096
17097be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17099 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17100 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17101 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17102 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017103 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17104 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017105
17106 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17107 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17108 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017110be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17112 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17113 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017114 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017115 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17116 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017117
17118 Example :
17119 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17120 backend dynamic
17121 mode http
17122 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17123 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017125bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017126 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17127 of the string.
17128
17129bool(<bool>) : bool
17130 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17131 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017133connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017135 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17137 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017138
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017139 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017140 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017141 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17142
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017143 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17144 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017145
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017146 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017147 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017149 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017150 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017151 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017152 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017154 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17155 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017156 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017157 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017158
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017159cpu_calls : integer
17160 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17161 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17162 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17163 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17164 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17165 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17166
17167cpu_ns_avg : integer
17168 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17169 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17170 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17171 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17172 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17173 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17174 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17175 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17176 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17177 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17178 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17179
17180cpu_ns_tot : integer
17181 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17182 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17183 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17184 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17185 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17186 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17187 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17188 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17189 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17190 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17191 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17192 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17193 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17194
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017195date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017196 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017197
17198 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17199 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17200 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017201 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17202
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017203 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17204 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17205 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17206 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17207 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17208
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017209 Example :
17210
17211 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17212 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017213
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017214 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17215 # millisecond granularity
17216 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17217
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017218date_us : integer
17219 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17220 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17221 from the same timeval structure.
17222
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017223distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17224 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17225 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17226 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17227 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17228 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17229 list of supported tokens.
17230
17231distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17232 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17233 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17234 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17235 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17236 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17237 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17238 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17239 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17240 supported tokens.
17241
17242 Example :
17243 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17244 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17245 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17246 # send large files to the big farm
17247 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17248
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017249env(<name>) : string
17250 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17251 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17252 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17253 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17254 certain way.
17255
17256 Examples :
17257 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17258 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17259
17260 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17261 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17264 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017265 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17266 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17268 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017269 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17271 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017272
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017273fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17275 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17276 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017278fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17280 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17281 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17282 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17283 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17284 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17285 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17286 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017287
17288 Example :
17289 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17290 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17291 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17292 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17293 frontend mail
17294 bind :25
17295 mode tcp
17296 maxconn 100
17297 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17298 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17299 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17300 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017301
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017302hostname : string
17303 Returns the system hostname.
17304
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017305int(<integer>) : signed integer
17306 Returns a signed integer.
17307
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017308ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17309 Returns an ipv4.
17310
17311ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17312 Returns an ipv6.
17313
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017314lat_ns_avg : integer
17315 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17316 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17317 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17318 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17319 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17320 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17321 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17322 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17323 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017324 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17325 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17326 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17327 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17328 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17329 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017330
17331lat_ns_tot : integer
17332 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17333 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17334 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17335 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17336 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17337 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17338 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17339 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17340 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017341 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17342 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17343 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17344 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17345 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017346 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17347 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17348 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17349 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17350 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17351 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17352
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017353meth(<method>) : method
17354 Returns a method.
17355
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017356nbproc : integer
17357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17358 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17359 and debugging purposes.
17360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017361nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17363 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17364 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017365 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17366 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17367 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017368
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017369prio_class : integer
17370 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17371 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17372 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17373
17374prio_offset : integer
17375 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17376 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17377 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17378 set-priority-offset".
17379
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017380proc : integer
17381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17382 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17383 debugging purposes.
17384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017386 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17387 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17388 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17390 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17391 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17392 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17393 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17394
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017395rand([<range>]) : integer
17396 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17397 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17398 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17399 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17400 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17401
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017402uuid([<version>]) : string
17403 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17404 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17405 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17409 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17410 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17411 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17412 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017413 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17414 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17415
17416srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17418 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17419 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17420 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17421 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17422 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17423 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17424
17425 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17426 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427
17428srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17429 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17430 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17431 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17434 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17435 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17436
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017437srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17439 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17440 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17441 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17442 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17443 fetch methods.
17444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17446 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17447 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017448 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17450 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017451 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452 overloading servers).
17453
17454 Example :
17455 # Redirect to a separate back
17456 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17457 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17458 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17459
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017460srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017461 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17462 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17463 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17464
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017465srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017466 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17467 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17468 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17469
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017470srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017471 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17472 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17473 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17474
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017475stopping : boolean
17476 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17477 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17478 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17479
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017480str(<string>) : string
17481 Returns a string.
17482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17484 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17486
17487table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17488 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17489 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17490 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17491
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017492thread : integer
17493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17494 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17495 and debugging purposes.
17496
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017497var(<var-name>) : undefined
17498 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017499 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17500 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017504 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17506 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017507 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017508 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511----------------------------------
17512
17513The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17514closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17515methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17516sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17517TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017518the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17519counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017520"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17521used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17522can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17523Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17524table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17525tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17526currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017528bc_dst : ip
17529 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17530 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17531 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17532 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17533
17534bc_dst_port : integer
17535 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17536 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17537
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017538bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017539 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17540 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17541 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17542
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017543bc_src : ip
17544 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17545 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17546 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17547 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17548
17549bc_src_port : integer
17550 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17551 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553be_id : integer
17554 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017555 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17556 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017558be_name : string
17559 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017560 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17561 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017562
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017563be_server_timeout : integer
17564 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17565 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17566 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17567
17568be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17569 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17570 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17571 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17572
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017573cur_server_timeout : integer
17574 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17575 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17576 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17577
17578cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17579 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17580 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17581 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583dst : ip
17584 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17585 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17586 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17587 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017588 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17589 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17590 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17591 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17592 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17593 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594
17595dst_conn : integer
17596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17597 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17598 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17599 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17600 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17601 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17602 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17603 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017604
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017605dst_is_local : boolean
17606 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17607 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17608 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17609 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017610 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017611 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17612 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17613 it only once per connection.
17614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615dst_port : integer
17616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17617 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17618 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17619 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17620 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17621 an HTTP header.
17622
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017623fc_http_major : integer
17624 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17625 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17626 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17627
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017628fc_pp_authority : string
17629 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17630 if any.
17631
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017632fc_pp_unique_id : string
17633 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17634 if any.
17635
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017636fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17637 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17638 header.
17639
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017640fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17641 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17642 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17643 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17644 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17645 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17646 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17647
17648fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17649 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17650 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17651 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17652 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17653 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17654 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17655
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017656fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017657 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17658 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17659 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17660 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17661
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017662fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017663 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17664 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17665 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17666 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17667
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017668fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017669 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17670 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17671 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17672 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17673
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017674fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017675 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17676 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17677 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17678 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17679
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017680fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017681 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17682 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17683 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17684 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17685
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017686fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017687 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17688 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17689 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17690 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17691
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017692fe_defbe : string
17693 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17694 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017696fe_id : integer
17697 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017698 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17700
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017701fe_name : string
17702 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17703 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17704 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17705
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017706fe_client_timeout : integer
17707 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17708 current frontend.
17709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017710sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017711sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17712sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17713sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017714 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17715 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17716 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017718sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017719sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17720sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17721sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017722 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17723 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17724 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017726sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017727sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17728sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17729sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017730 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17731 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017732 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17733 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17734 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017735
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017736 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017737 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17738 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017739 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17740 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17741 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017742 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17743 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17744
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017745sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17746sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17747sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17748sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17749 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17750 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17751 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17752 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17753 when a first ACL was verified.
17754
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017755sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017756sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17757sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17758sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017760 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017762sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017763sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17764sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17765sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017766 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17767 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17768 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017770sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017771sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17772sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17773sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017774 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17775 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17776 See also src_conn_rate.
17777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017778sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017779sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17780sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17781sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017782 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017783 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017784
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017785sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17786sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17787sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17788sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17789 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17790 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17791
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017792sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17793sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17794sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17795sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17796 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17797 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017799sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017800sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17801sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17802sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017803 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17804 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17805 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017806 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17807 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17808 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017809
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017810sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17811sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17812sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17813sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17814 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17815 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17816 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17817 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17818 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17819 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017821sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017822sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17823sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17824sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017825 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017826 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17827 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17828
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017829sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017830sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17831sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17832sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017833 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17834 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17835 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17836 src_http_err_rate.
17837
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017838sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17839sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17840sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17841sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17842 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17843 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17844 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17845
17846sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17847sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17848sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17849sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17850 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17851 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17852 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17853 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17854
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017855sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017856sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17857sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17858sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017859 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017860 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17861 src_http_req_cnt.
17862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017863sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017864sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17865sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17866sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017867 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17868 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17869 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17870 src_http_req_rate.
17871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017872sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017873sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17874sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17875sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017876 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017877 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17878 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17879 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17880 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017881
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017882 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017883 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17884 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017885 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17886
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017887sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17888sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17889sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17890sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17891 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17892 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17893 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17894 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17895 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17896
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017897sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017898sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17899sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17900sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017901 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17902 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17903 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017905sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017906sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17907sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17908sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017909 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17910 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17911 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017913sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017914sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17915sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17916sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017917 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017918 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17919 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17920 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017921 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017922 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017924sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017925sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17926sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17927sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017928 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17929 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17930 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17931 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17932 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017933 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017934
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017935sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017936sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17937sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17938sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017939 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17940 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17941 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017943sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017944sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17945sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17946sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017947 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17948 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017949 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017950 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17951 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17953 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17954 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017956so_id : integer
17957 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17958 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17959 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017960
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017961so_name : string
17962 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17963 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17964 strings instead of integers.
17965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017967 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17969 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17970 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017971 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17972 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17973 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017974 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17975 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17976 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17977 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17978 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17979 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17980 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017981
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017982 Example:
17983 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17984 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017986src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17987 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17988 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17989 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017990 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017992src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17993 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17994 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017995 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017996 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17999 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18000 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18001 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18002 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18003 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18004 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018005
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018006 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018007 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18008 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18009 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18010 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018011 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018012 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18013 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18014
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018015src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18016 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18017 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18018 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18019 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18020 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18021 was verified.
18022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018024 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018026 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018027 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018030 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18032 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018033 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18036 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18037 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18038 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018039 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018042 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018044 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018045 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018047src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18048 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18049 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18050 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18051 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18052
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018053src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18054 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18055 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18056 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18057 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018059src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018060 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018061 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018062 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18063 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018064 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18065 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18066 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018067
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018068src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18069 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18070 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18071 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18072 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18073 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18074 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18075 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018080 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018081 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018082 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018084src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18085 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18086 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18087 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18088 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018089 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018090
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018091src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18092 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18093 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018094 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018095 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18096 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18097
18098src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18099 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18100 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18101 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18102 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18103 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18104 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018106src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018107 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018108 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18109 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018110 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18113 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18114 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18115 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018116 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018117 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18120 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18121 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18122 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018123 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018124 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18125 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018126
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018127 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018128 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018129 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018130 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018131
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018132src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18133 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18134 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18135 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18136 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18137 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18138 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18139
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018140src_is_local : boolean
18141 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18142 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18143 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18144 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018145 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018146 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18147 once per connection.
18148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018150 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18151 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18152 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18153 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18154 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018157 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18158 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18159 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18160 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18161 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163src_port : integer
18164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18165 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18166 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18167 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018170 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018171 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18172 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18173 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018174 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018176src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18177 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18178 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18179 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18180 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018181 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18184 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18185 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18186 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18187 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18188 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18189 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18190 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18191 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018192
18193 Example :
18194 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18195 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18196 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18197 listen ssh
18198 bind :22
18199 mode tcp
18200 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018201 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018203 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205srv_id : integer
18206 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18207 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018208 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018209
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018210srv_name : string
18211 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18212 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018213 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182157.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018216----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18219closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18220when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18221usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018222future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018223
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001822451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18225 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18226 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18227 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18228 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18229 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18230
18231 Example :
18232 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18233 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18234 # the request.
18235 frontend http-in
18236 bind *:8081
18237 default_backend servers
18238 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18239 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18240
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018241ssl_bc : boolean
18242 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18243 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018244 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18245 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018246
18247ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18248 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018249 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18250 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018251
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018252ssl_bc_alpn : string
18253 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18254 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018255 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018256 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18257 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18258 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18259 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18260 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018261 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18262 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018263
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018264ssl_bc_cipher : string
18265 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018266 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18267 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018268
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018269ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18270 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18271 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18272 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018273 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018274
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018275ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18276 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18277 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018278 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18279 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018280
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018281ssl_bc_npn : string
18282 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18283 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018284 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018285 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18286 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18287 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18288 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018289 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18290 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018291
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018292ssl_bc_protocol : string
18293 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018294 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18295 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018296
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018297ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018298 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018299 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018300 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18301 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018302
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018303ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18304 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18305 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18306 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018307 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018308
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018309ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18310 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18311 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018312 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18313 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018314
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018315ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18316 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18317 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18318 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018319 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018320
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018321ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18322 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018323 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18324 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18327 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18328 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18329 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18330 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18331 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18334 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18335 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18336 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18337 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018338
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018339ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018340 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18341 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18342 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018343 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018344 does not support resumed sessions.
18345
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018346ssl_c_der : binary
18347 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18348 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18349 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351ssl_c_err : integer
18352 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18353 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18354 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18355 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18356 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018357
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018358ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18360 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18361 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18362 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18363 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18364 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18365 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18366 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018367 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18368 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18369 LDAP v3.
18370 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18371 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373ssl_c_key_alg : string
18374 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18375 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18376 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378ssl_c_notafter : string
18379 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18380 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18381 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383ssl_c_notbefore : string
18384 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18385 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18386 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018387
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018388ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18390 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18391 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18392 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18393 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18394 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18395 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18396 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018397 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18398 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18399 LDAP v3.
18400 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18401 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018403ssl_c_serial : binary
18404 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18405 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18406 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18409 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18410 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18411 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018412 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18413 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18414
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018415 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018416 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18419 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18420 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18421 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423ssl_c_used : boolean
18424 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18425 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_c_verify : integer
18428 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18429 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18430 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18431 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433ssl_c_version : integer
18434 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18435 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018436
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018437ssl_f_der : binary
18438 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18439 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18440 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18441
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018442ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18444 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18445 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18446 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018447 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018448 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18449 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18450 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018451 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18452 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18453 LDAP v3.
18454 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18455 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_f_key_alg : string
18458 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18459 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18460 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462ssl_f_notafter : string
18463 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18464 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18465 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467ssl_f_notbefore : string
18468 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18469 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18470 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018471
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018472ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018473 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18474 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18475 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18476 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18477 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18478 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18479 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18480 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018481 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18482 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18483 LDAP v3.
18484 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18485 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487ssl_f_serial : binary
18488 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18489 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18490 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018491
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018492ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18493 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18494 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18495 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18498 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18499 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18500 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502ssl_f_version : integer
18503 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18504 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18505
18506ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018507 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18508 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18509 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511 Example :
18512 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18513 listen http-https
18514 bind :80
18515 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18516 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18517
18518ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18519 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18520 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18521
18522ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018523 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018524 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18525 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18526 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18527 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18528 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18529 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18530 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18531 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533ssl_fc_cipher : string
18534 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18535 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018536
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018537ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18538 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18539 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018540 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018541
18542ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18543 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18544 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018545 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018546
18547ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18548 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18549 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18550 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018551 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018552 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018553
18554ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18555 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18556 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018557 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018558
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018559ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18560 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18561 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18562 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18563
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018564ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18565 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18566 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18567 transport layer.
18568 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18569 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18570 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18571 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18572
18573ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18574 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18575 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18576 transport layer.
18577 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18578 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18579 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18580 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18581
18582ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18583 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18584 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18585 transport layer.
18586 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18587 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18588 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18589 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18590
18591ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18592 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18593 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18594 transport layer.
18595 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18596 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18597 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18598 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18599
18600ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18601 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18602 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18603 transport layer.
18604 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18605 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18606 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18607 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018609ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018610 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18611 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018612 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18613 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18614 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18615 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018616
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018617ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18618 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18619 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18620 wait until the handshake happened.
18621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018622ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18623 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018624 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18625 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018626 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018627 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018628
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018629ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018630 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018631 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18632 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018635 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018636 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18637 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18638 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18639 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18640 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18641 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18642 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644ssl_fc_protocol : string
18645 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18646 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018647
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018648ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018649 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018650 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18651 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018652
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018653ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18654 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18655 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18656 transport layer.
18657 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18658 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18659 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18660 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18661
18662ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18663 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18664 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18665 transport layer.
18666 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18667 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18668 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18669 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18670
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018671ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18672 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18673 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18674 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18677 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18678 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18679 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18680 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018681
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018682ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18683 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18684 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18685 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18686 BoringSSL.
18687
18688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689ssl_fc_sni : string
18690 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18691 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18692 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18693 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18694 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18695
18696 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18697 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18698 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018699 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018700 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18704 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18707 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18708 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018709
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018710ssl_s_der : binary
18711 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18712 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18713 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18714
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018715ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18716 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18717 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18718 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018719 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018720 does not support resumed sessions.
18721
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018722ssl_s_key_alg : string
18723 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18724 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18725 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18726
18727ssl_s_notafter : string
18728 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18729 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18730 transport layer.
18731
18732ssl_s_notbefore : string
18733 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18734 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18735 transport layer.
18736
18737ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18738 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18739 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18740 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18741 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18742 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18743 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018744 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18745 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018746 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18747 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18748 LDAP v3.
18749 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18750 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18751
18752ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18753 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18754 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18755 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18756 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18757 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18758 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018759 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18760 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018761 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18762 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18763 LDAP v3.
18764 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18765 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18766
18767ssl_s_serial : binary
18768 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18769 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18770 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18771
18772ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18773 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18774 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18775 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18776
18777ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18778 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18779 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18780 layer.
18781
18782ssl_s_version : integer
18783 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18784 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018785
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187867.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18790sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18791only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18792For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18793be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18794can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18795sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18796for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18797content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018798
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018799Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18800 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18801 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18802 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18803 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18804 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18805 sample expression). So be careful.
18806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018808 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018809 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18810 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018812payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18813 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018814 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817req.len : integer
18818req_len : integer (deprecated)
18819 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18820 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18821 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18822 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18823 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18824 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18825 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18826 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18829 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018830 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18831 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18832 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18833 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835 ACL alternatives :
18836 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18839 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18840 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18841 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18842 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844 ACL alternatives :
18845 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018847 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849req.proto_http : boolean
18850req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18851 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18852 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18853 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18854 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18855 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18856 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18857 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859 Example:
18860 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18861 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18862 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018863 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18866rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18867 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18868 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18869 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18870 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18871 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18872 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18873 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18876 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18877 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18878 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18879 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18880 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018882 ACL derivatives :
18883 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018885 Example :
18886 listen tse-farm
18887 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18888 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18889 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18890 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18891 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18892 persist rdp-cookie
18893 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18894 # This is only useful makes sense if
18895 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18896 stick-table type string size 204800
18897 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18898 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18899 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18902 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18905rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18906 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18907 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18908 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18909 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911 ACL derivatives :
18912 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018913
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018914req.ssl_alpn : string
18915 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18916 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18917 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18918 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18919 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18920 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018921 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018922
18923 Examples :
18924 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18926 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018927 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018928 default_backend bk_default
18929
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018930req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18931 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18932 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018933 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18934 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18935 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18936 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18937 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18940req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18941 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18942 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18943 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18944 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18945 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18946 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18947 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018949req.ssl_sni : string
18950req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18951 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18952 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18953 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18954 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18955 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018956 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18957 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18958 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18959 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18960 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18961 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18962 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18963 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18964 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018966 ACL derivatives :
18967 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969 Examples :
18970 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18971 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18972 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18973 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18974 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018975
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018976req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18977 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18978 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18979 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18980 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18981 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18982 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18983 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18984 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18985 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987req.ssl_ver : integer
18988req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18989 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18990 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18991 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18992 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18993 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18994 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18995 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018996 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999 ACL derivatives :
19000 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019001
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019002res.len : integer
19003 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19004 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19005 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19006 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19007 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
19008 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
19009 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019010 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19013 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019014 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019015 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019016 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019017 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019019res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19020 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19021 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19022 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019023 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19024 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019027
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019028res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19029rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19030 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19031 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19032 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19033 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19034 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19035 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19036 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019038wait_end : boolean
19039 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19040 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019041 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19043 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019044 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19046 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019048 Examples :
19049 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19050 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19051 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19054 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19055 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19056 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19057 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19058 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19059 tcp-request content reject
19060
19061
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190627.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063--------------------------------------
19064
19065It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19066This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19067data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19068its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19069HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19070content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19071to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19072more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19073response are indexed.
19074
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019075Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19076 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19077 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19078 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19079 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19080 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19081 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083base : string
19084 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19085 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19086 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19087 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19088 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19089 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19090 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19091 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19092
19093 ACL derivatives :
19094 base : exact string match
19095 base_beg : prefix match
19096 base_dir : subdir match
19097 base_dom : domain match
19098 base_end : suffix match
19099 base_len : length match
19100 base_reg : regex match
19101 base_sub : substring match
19102
19103base32 : integer
19104 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19105 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19106 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019107 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19108 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19109 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110
19111base32+src : binary
19112 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19113 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19114 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19115 per-URL counters.
19116
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019117baseq : string
19118 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19119 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19120 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19121 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19122
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019123capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19124 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19125 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19126 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19127
19128capture.req.method : string
19129 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19130 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19131 because it's allocated.
19132
19133capture.req.uri : string
19134 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19135 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19136 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19137 allocated.
19138
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019139capture.req.ver : string
19140 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19141 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19142 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19143
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019144capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19145 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19146 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19147 The first entry is an index of 0.
19148 See also: "capture response header"
19149
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019150capture.res.ver : string
19151 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19152 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19153 persistent flag.
19154
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019155req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019156 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19157 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19158 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019159
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019160req.body_param([<name>) : string
19161 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19162 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19163 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19164 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19165 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19166 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19167 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19168 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19169 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19170 given.
19171
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019172req.body_len : integer
19173 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19174 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019175 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19176 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019177
19178req.body_size : integer
19179 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019180 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19181 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183req.cook([<name>]) : string
19184cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19185 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19186 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19187 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19188 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19189 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19190 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19191 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19192 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19193
19194 ACL derivatives :
19195 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19196 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19197 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19198 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19199 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19200 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19201 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19202 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019204req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19205cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19206 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19207 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19210cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19212 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19213 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19214 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019216cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19217 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19218 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19219 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19220 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019221 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19223 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19224 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19225 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019227hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19228 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19229 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19230 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19231 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019232 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019234req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019235 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19236 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19237 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19238 with headers such as User-Agent.
19239
19240 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19241 found.
19242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19244 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19245 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019246 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19249 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19250 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019251 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19252 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019254req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019255 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19256 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19257 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19258 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19259 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19260 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19261 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19262
19263 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19264 found.
19265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019266 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19267 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19268 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019269 with -1 being the last one.
19270
19271 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19272 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019274 ACL derivatives :
19275 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19276 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19277 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19278 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19279 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19280 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19281 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19282 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19283
19284req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19285hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19286 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19287 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019288 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19289 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19290 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19291
19292 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19293 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19294 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19295
19296 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297
19298req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19299hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19300 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19301 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19302 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019303 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19304 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19305 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19306 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19307 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019308
19309 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19310
19311 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312
19313req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19314hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19315 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19316 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19317 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019318
19319 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19320
19321 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019323req.hdrs : string
19324 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19325 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19326 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19327 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19328
19329req.hdrs_bin : binary
19330 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19331 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19332 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19333 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19334 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19335 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19336
19337 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019338
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019339 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19340 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19343 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19344 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19345 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19346 basic auth is supported.
19347
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019348http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19349 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19350 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19351 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19352 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19354 basic auth is supported.
19355
19356 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019357 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19358 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19359 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19360 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019362http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019363 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19364 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19365 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019366
19367http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019368 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19369 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19370 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019371
19372http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019373 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19374 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19375 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019378 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19379 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19381 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383method : integer + string
19384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19385 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19386 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19387 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19388 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19389 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19390 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392 ACL derivatives :
19393 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395 Example :
19396 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19397 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19398 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400path : string
19401 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19402 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19403 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19404 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19405 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019406 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019409 ACL derivatives :
19410 path : exact string match
19411 path_beg : prefix match
19412 path_dir : subdir match
19413 path_dom : domain match
19414 path_end : suffix match
19415 path_len : length match
19416 path_reg : regex match
19417 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019418
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019419pathq : string
19420 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19421 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19422 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19423 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19424 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19425 result in both cases.
19426
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019427query : string
19428 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19429 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19430 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19431 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019432 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019433 which stops before the question mark.
19434
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019435req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19436 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19437 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19438 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19439 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441req.ver : string
19442req_ver : string (deprecated)
19443 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19444 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19445 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019447 ACL derivatives :
19448 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019449
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019450res.body : binary
19451 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19452 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019453 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19454
19455 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019456
19457res.body_len : integer
19458 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19459 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019460 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19461
19462 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019463
19464res.body_size : integer
19465 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19466 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19467 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19468 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019469 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19470
19471 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019472
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019473res.cache_hit : boolean
19474 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19475 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19476
19477res.cache_name : string
19478 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19479 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19480 empty string.
19481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482res.comp : boolean
19483 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19484 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19485 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019487res.comp_algo : string
19488 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19489 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19490 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492res.cook([<name>]) : string
19493scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19494 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19495 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019496 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19497
19498 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500 ACL derivatives :
19501 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19504scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19505 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19506 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019507 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19508
19509 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19512scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19513 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19514 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019515 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19516
19517 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019520 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19521 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19522
19523 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19524 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19525
19526 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19527
19528 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19532 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19533
19534 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19535 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19536
19537 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19540shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019541 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19542 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19543
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019544 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019545 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19546
19547 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549 ACL derivatives :
19550 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19551 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19552 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19553 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19554 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19555 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19556 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19557 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19558
19559res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19560shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019561 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19562 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19563
19564 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019565 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019566
19567 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19570shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019571 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19572 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19573
19574 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19575
19576 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019577
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019578res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19579 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19580 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19581 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019582 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19583
19584 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019586res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19587shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019588 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19589 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19590
19591 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19592
19593 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019594
19595res.hdrs : string
19596 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19597 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19598 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019599 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19600
19601 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019602
19603res.hdrs_bin : binary
19604 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19605 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19606 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19607 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19608 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19609 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19610 (length of 0 for both).
19611
19612 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19613
19614 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19615 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019617res.ver : string
19618resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19619 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019620 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19621
19622 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019624 ACL derivatives :
19625 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19628 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19629 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019630 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019631 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019633 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19634 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019636status : integer
19637 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19638 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019639 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19640
19641 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019642
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019643unique-id : string
19644 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19645 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19646 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19647 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19648 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19649 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019651url : string
19652 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19653 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19654 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19655 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19656 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19657 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19658 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660 ACL derivatives :
19661 url : exact string match
19662 url_beg : prefix match
19663 url_dir : subdir match
19664 url_dom : domain match
19665 url_end : suffix match
19666 url_len : length match
19667 url_reg : regex match
19668 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670url_ip : ip
19671 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19672 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19673 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19674 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19675 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19676 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19677 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679url_port : integer
19680 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19681 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19682 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19683 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019684
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019685urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19686url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19688 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019689 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19690 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19691 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19692 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19694 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019695 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19696 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698 ACL derivatives :
19699 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19700 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19701 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19702 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19703 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19704 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19705 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19706 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019707
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709 Example :
19710 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19711 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19712 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19713 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019714
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019715urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019716 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19717 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19718 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019719
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019720url32 : integer
19721 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19722 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19723 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19724 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19725 is an unsigned integer.
19726
19727url32+src : binary
19728 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19729 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19730 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19731
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019732
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197337.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019734---------------------------------------
19735
19736This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19737used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19738purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19739There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19740or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19741any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19742for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19743
19744internal.htx.data : integer
19745 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19746 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19747
19748internal.htx.free : integer
19749 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19750 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19751
19752internal.htx.free_data : integer
19753 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19754 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19755
19756internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019757 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19758 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19759 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019760
19761internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19762 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19763 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19764
19765internal.htx.size : integer
19766 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19767 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19768
19769internal.htx.used : integer
19770 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19771 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19772 direction.
19773
19774internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19775 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19776 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19777 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19778 of the special value :
19779 * head : The oldest inserted block
19780 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019781 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019782
19783internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19784 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19785 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19786 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19787 integer or one of the special value :
19788 * head : The oldest inserted block
19789 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019790 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019791
19792internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19793 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19794 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19795 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19796 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19797
19798 * head : The oldest inserted block
19799 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019800 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019801
19802internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19803 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19804 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19805 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19806 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19807
19808 * head : The oldest inserted block
19809 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019810 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019811
19812internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19813 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19814 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19815 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19816 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19817
19818 * head : The oldest inserted block
19819 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019820 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019821
19822internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19823 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19824 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19825 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19826 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19827
19828 * head : The oldest inserted block
19829 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019830 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019831
19832internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19833 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19834 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19835 it returns false.
19836
19837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198387.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019839---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019841Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19842every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019843order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019845ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019846---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19847FALSE always_false never match
19848HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19849HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19850HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019851HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019852HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19853HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19854HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19855HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19856LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19857METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19858METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19859METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19860METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19861METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19862METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19863METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19864METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19865RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19866REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19867TRUE always_true always match
19868WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19869---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019870
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198728. Logging
19873----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019875One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19876provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19877very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19878provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19879state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019880to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019881headers.
19882
19883In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19884about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19885send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19886
19887 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19888 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19889 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19890 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19891 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019892 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019893 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019894
19895The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19896allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19897as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19898while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19899real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19900delay.
19901
19902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199038.1. Log levels
19904---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019905
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019906TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019907source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019908HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19909in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19910track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19911syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19912about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019913
19914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199158.2. Log formats
19916----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019917
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019918HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019919and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19920slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19921options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019922
19923 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19924 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19925 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19926 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19927 extents.
19928
19929 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19930 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19931 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19932 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19933 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19934
19935 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19936 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19937 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19938 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19939 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19940
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019941 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19942 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19943 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19944 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19945
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019946 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019948Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19949specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19950field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19951servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19952always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19953identifier.
19954
19955Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19956 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19957 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19958 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19959 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19960
19961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199628.2.1. Default log format
19963-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964
19965This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19966as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19967format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19968
19969 Example :
19970 listen www
19971 mode http
19972 log global
19973 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19974
19975 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19976 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19977 (www/HTTP)
19978
19979 Field Format Extract from the example above
19980 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19981 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19982 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19983 4 'to' to
19984 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19985 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19986
19987Detailed fields description :
19988 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19989 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19990 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19991 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19992 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19993 and processed the connection.
19994 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19995
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019996In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19997"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19998connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020000It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20001will eventually disappear.
20002
20003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200048.2.2. TCP log format
20005---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020006
20007The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20008is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20009information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20010counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20011emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20012environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20013the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20014sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020015specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20016not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20017fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20018marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020019
20020 Example :
20021 frontend fnt
20022 mode tcp
20023 option tcplog
20024 log global
20025 default_backend bck
20026
20027 backend bck
20028 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20029
20030 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20031 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20032 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20033
20034 Field Format Extract from the example above
20035 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20036 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20037 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20038 4 frontend_name fnt
20039 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20040 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20041 7 bytes_read* 212
20042 8 termination_state --
20043 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20044 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20045
20046Detailed fields description :
20047 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020048 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20049 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20050 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020051 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020052 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020053 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020054
20055 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020056 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20057 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20058 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020059
20060 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20061 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20062 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020063 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20064 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20065 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20066 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020067
20068 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20069 and processed the connection.
20070
20071 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20072 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20073 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20074 applications.
20075
20076 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20077 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20078 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20079 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20080 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20081
20082 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20083 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20084 See "Timers" below for more details.
20085
20086 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20087 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20088 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20089 "Timers" below for more details.
20090
20091 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020092 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020093 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20094 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20095 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20096 details.
20097
20098 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20099 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20100 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20101 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20102 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20103
20104 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20105 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20106 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20107 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20108 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20109 for more details.
20110
20111 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020112 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20114 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20115 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020116 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117
20118 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20119 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20120 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20121 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20122 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20123 caused by a denial of service attack.
20124
20125 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20126 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20127 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20128 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20129 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20130 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20131 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20132 denial of service attack.
20133
20134 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20135 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20136 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20137 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20138 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20139 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20140 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20141 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20142 be processed than on other servers.
20143
20144 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20145 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20146 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20147 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20148 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20149 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20150 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20151 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20152 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20153 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20154 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20155 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20156 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20157
20158 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20159 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20160 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20161 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20162 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20163 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020164 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020165 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20166
20167 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20168 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20169 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20170 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20171 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20172 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020173 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20175 occurs.
20176
20177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201788.2.3. HTTP log format
20179----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020180
20181The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20182is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20183the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20184are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20185emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20186generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20187"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20188which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020189frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20190is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20193slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20194with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20195
20196 Example :
20197 frontend http-in
20198 mode http
20199 option httplog
20200 log global
20201 default_backend bck
20202
20203 backend static
20204 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20205
20206 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20207 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20208 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020209 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020210
20211 Field Format Extract from the example above
20212 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20213 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020214 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020215 4 frontend_name http-in
20216 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020217 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020218 7 status_code 200
20219 8 bytes_read* 2750
20220 9 captured_request_cookie -
20221 10 captured_response_cookie -
20222 11 termination_state ----
20223 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20224 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20225 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20226 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20227 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020228
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020229Detailed fields description :
20230 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020231 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20232 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20233 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020234 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020235 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020236 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020237
20238 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020239 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20240 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20241 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020243 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20244 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245
20246 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20247 and processed the connection.
20248
20249 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20250 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20251 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20252
20253 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20254 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20255 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20256 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20257 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20258 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20259
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020260 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20261 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20262 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020263 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020264 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20265 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020266 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20267 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020268
20269 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20270 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020271 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272
20273 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20274 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020275 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20276 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277
20278 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20279 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20280 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20281 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20282 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020283 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20284 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020285
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020286 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20287 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20288 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20289 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20290 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20291 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20292 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020293 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020294
20295 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20296 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20297 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20298
20299 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20300 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020301 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020302 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20303 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20304 overflowing.
20305
20306 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20307 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20308 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20309 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20310 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20311 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20312 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20313 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20314
20315 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20316 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20317 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20318 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20319 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20320 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20321 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20322 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20323
20324 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20325 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20326 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20327 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20328 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20329 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20330 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20331
20332 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020333 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020334 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20335 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20336 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020337 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020338 system.
20339
20340 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20341 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20342 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20343 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20344 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20345 caused by a denial of service attack.
20346
20347 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20348 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20349 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20350 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20351 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20352 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20353 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20354 denial of service attack.
20355
20356 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20357 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20358 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20359 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20360 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20361 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20362 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20363 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20364 processed than on other servers.
20365
20366 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20367 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20368 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20369 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20370 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20371 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20372 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20373 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20374 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20375 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20376 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20377 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20378 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20379
20380 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20381 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20382 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20383 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20384 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20385 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020386 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020387 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20388
20389 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20390 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20391 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20392 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20393 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20394 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020395 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020396 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20397 occurs.
20398
20399 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20400 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20401 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20402 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20403 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20404 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20405 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20406 cookies" below for more details.
20407
20408 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20409 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20410 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20411 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20412 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20413 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20414 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20415 and cookies" below for more details.
20416
20417 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20418 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20419 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20420 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20421 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20422 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20423 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20424 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20425
20426
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204278.2.4. Custom log format
20428------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020429
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020430The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020431mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020433HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020434Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20435separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20436prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20437
20438Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20439variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020440("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020441
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020442If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020443as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020444less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20445the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20446
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020447Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20448"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20449delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20450preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020451
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020452Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20453'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20454https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20455such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20456
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020457Flags are :
20458 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020459 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020460 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20461 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020462
20463 Example:
20464
20465 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20466 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20467
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020468 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20469
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020470At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20471
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020472 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20473 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020474
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020475the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020477 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20478 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20479 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020480
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020481and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20482
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020483 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20484 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020485
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020486Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20487
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020488 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020489 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020490 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20491 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20492 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020493 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20494 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20495 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020496 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020497 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020498 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020499 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020500 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020501 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20502 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020503 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020504 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020505 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020506 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020507 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020508 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020509 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020510 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20511 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20512 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20513 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20514 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020515 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020516 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020517 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020518 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020519 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020520 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20521 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020522 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20523 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20524 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020525 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020526 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20527 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020528 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020529 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20530 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20531 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020532 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020533 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020534 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20535 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20536 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20537 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020538 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020539 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020540 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020541 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020542 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020543 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020544 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20545 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20546 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020547 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020548 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20549 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020550 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020551 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20552 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020553 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020554 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020555 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020556 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020557
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020558 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020559
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020560
205618.2.5. Error log format
20562-----------------------
20563
20564When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20565protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20566By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20567"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020568will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020569logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20570
20571The format looks like this :
20572
20573 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20574 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20575 Connection error during SSL handshake
20576
20577 Field Format Extract from the example above
20578 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20579 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20580 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20581 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20582 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20583
20584These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20585failures.
20586
20587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205888.3. Advanced logging options
20589-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590
20591Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20592just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20593options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20594for more information about their usage.
20595
20596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20598------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020599
20600It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20601haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20602commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20603monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20604ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20605
20606 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20607 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20608 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20609 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20610
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020611 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20612 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020613
20614 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20615 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20616 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20617
20618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206198.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20620----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020621
20622The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20623what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20624or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020625"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020626just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20627log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20628after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20629is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20630with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20631with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20632
20633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206348.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20635------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020636
20637Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20638for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20639"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20640retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20641raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20642a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20643file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20644you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20645"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20646
20647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206488.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20649--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020650
20651Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20652multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20653them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20654"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20655logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20656error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20657and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20658too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20659useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20660alternative.
20661
20662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206638.4. Timing events
20664------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020665
20666Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20667reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20668the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20669frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020670mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20671addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20672
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020673Timings events in HTTP mode:
20674
20675 first request 2nd request
20676 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20677 t tr t tr ...
20678 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20679 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20680 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20681 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020682 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020683 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20684
20685Timings events in TCP mode:
20686
20687 TCP session
20688 |<----------------->|
20689 t t
20690 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20691 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20692 |<------ Tt ------->|
20693
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020694 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020695 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020696 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20697 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20698 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020699 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020700 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20701 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20702 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20703 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020705 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20706 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20707 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020708 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20709 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20710 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20711 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20712 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20713 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020714
20715 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20716 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20717 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20718 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20719 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20720 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20721 request typed by hand during a test.
20722
20723 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20724 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020725 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020726 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20727 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20728 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20729 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020730
20731 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20732 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20733 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20734 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20735 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20736
20737 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20738 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20739 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20740 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20741 connection never established.
20742
20743 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20744 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20745 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20746 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20747 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20748 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20749 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20750 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20751 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20752 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20753 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20754
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020755 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20756 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20757 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20758 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20759 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20760 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20761
20762 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20763
20764 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20765 "Ta" can never be negative.
20766
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020767 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20768 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020769 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20770 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020771 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020772
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020773 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020774
20775 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020776 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20777 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020779 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20780 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20781 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20782 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20783 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20784 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20785 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20786 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20789protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20790that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020791due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20792"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20793that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020794
20795Most common cases :
20796
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020797 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20798 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20799 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20800 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20801 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20802 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20803 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20804 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20805 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20806 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20807 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020808 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020809
20810 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20811 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20812 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20813 of ms on remote networks.
20814
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020815 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20816 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20817 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020819 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20820 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20821 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20822 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20823 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20824 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20825 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20826 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20827 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020828
20829Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20830
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020831 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020832 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020833 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020834
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020835 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020836 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20837 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20838
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020839 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020840 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20841 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20842 flags.
20843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020844 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20845 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020846 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20847 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20848 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20849 the client connection was maintained open.
20850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020851 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020852 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020853 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020854 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20855
20856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208578.5. Session state at disconnection
20858-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020859
20860TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20861"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20863each of which has a special meaning :
20864
20865 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20866 session to terminate :
20867
20868 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20869
20870 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20871 server explicitly refused it.
20872
20873 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20874 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20875 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20876 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020877 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020878
20879 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20880 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020881
20882 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20883 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20884 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20885 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20886 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20887
20888 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20889 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20890 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20891 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20892 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20893
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020894 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20895 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20896
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020897 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20898 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20899 backup connections when going up.
20900
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020901 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20902
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020903 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20904 send or receive data.
20905
20906 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20907 send or receive data.
20908
20909 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20910 with nothing left in the buffers.
20911
20912 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20913
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020914 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020915 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20916
20917 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20918 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20919 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20920 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20921 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20922
20923 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20924 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20925
20926 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20927 server (HTTP only).
20928
20929 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20930
20931 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20932 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20933 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20934
20935 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20936 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20937 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20938
20939 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20940
20941 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20942 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20943
20944 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20945 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20946 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20947
20948 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20949 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020950 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20951 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020952
20953 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20954 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20955 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20956 another server.
20957
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020958 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020959 server.
20960
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020961 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20962 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20963 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20964 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20965
20966 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20967 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20968 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20969 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20970
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020971 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20972 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20973 "use-server" rule).
20974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020975 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20976
20977 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20978 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20979
20980 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20981
20982 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20983 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20984 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20985
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020986 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20987 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020988 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020989 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20990 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020992 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20993
20994 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20995 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20996
20997 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20998
20999 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21000
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021001The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21002was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021003helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21004starvation, attacks, etc...
21005
21006The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21007alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21008easier finding and understanding.
21009
21010 Flags Reason
21011
21012 -- Normal termination.
21013
21014 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
21015 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
21016 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
21017 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21018
21019 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21020 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
21021 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21022 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
21023 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21024 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021025
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021026 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21027 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021028 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021029
21030 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21031 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21032 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21033
21034 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21035 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21036 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21037 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21038 the server takes too long to respond.
21039
21040 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21041 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21042 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21043 long a time to respond.
21044
21045 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21046 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21047 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21048 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021049 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21050 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021051
21052 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21053 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21054 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21055 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21056 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021057 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021058 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21059 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21060 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21061 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21062 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21063 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21064 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21065 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021066 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021067 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21068 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21069 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
21071 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21072 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021073 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21074 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21075 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21076 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021077
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021078 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21079 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021081 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021082 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21083 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021084 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021085 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21086 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21087
21088 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21089 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21090 503 or 504 here.
21091
21092 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21093 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21094 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21095 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21096 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21097
21098 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21099 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021100 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021101 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21102 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21103
21104 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21105 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21106 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21107 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21108 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21109 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21110 between haproxy and the server.
21111
21112 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21113 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21114 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21115 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21116 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21117 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21118 solution is to fix the application.
21119
21120 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21121 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21122 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21123 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21124 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21125 external attacks.
21126
21127 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021128 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021129 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21131 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21132
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021133 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21134 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21135 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021136 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021137 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021139 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21140 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21141 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21142 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021143 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21144 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21145 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21146 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21147 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148
21149 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21150 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21151 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21152 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21153
21154 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21155 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21156 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21157 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21158
21159 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21160 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21161 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21162 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21163
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021164The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21165persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21166important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21167re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21168
21169 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21170
21171 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21172 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21173 set on a GET request.
21174
21175 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21176 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021177 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021178 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21179
21180 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21181 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21182 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21183
21184 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21185 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21186 already got a cookie.
21187
21188 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21189 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21190 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21191 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21192 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21193
21194 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21195 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21196 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21197
21198 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21199 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21200 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21201
21202 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21203 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21204
21205 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21206 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21207 then advertised in the response.
21208
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212108.6. Non-printable characters
21211-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021212
21213In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21214consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21215converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21216prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21217being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21218escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21219is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21220'}' when logging headers.
21221
21222Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21223issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21224containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21225
21226Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21227the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21228performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21229
21230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212318.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21232---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021233
21234Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21235achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021236section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21238the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21239the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021240locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021241not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21242user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21243a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21244wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21245
21246 Examples :
21247 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21248 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21249
21250 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21251 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21252
21253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212548.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21255---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021256
21257Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21258proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21259the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21260server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21261
21262Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21263response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021264section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021265
21266It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021267time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21268appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021269are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21270and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21271follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21272request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21273in the logs.
21274
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021275As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21276frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21277an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21278
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279 Example :
21280 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21281 listen proxy-out
21282 mode http
21283 option httplog
21284 option logasap
21285 log global
21286 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21287
21288 # log the name of the virtual server
21289 capture request header Host len 20
21290
21291 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21292 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21293
21294 # log the beginning of the referrer
21295 capture request header Referer len 20
21296
21297 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21298 capture response header Server len 20
21299
21300 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21301 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021303 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21305
21306 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21307 capture response header Via len 20
21308
21309 # log the URL location during a redirection
21310 capture response header Location len 20
21311
21312 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21313 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21314 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21315 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21316 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21317
21318 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21319 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21320 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21321 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021322 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021323
21324 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21325 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21326 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21327 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21328 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021329 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021330
21331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213328.9. Examples of logs
21333---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021334
21335These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21336them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21337reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21338
21339 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21340 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21341 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21342
21343 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21344 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21345
21346 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21347 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21348 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21349
21350 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21351 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21352
21353 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21354 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21355 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21356
21357 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021358 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021359 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21360 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21361
21362 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21363 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21364 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21365
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021366 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21367 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21368 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21369 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21370 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21371 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021372
21373 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021374 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021375
21376 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21377 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21378 Nothing was sent to any server.
21379
21380 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21381 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21382
21383 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21384 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021385 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021386 send a 408 return code to the client.
21387
21388 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21389 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21390
21391 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21392 5 seconds ("c----").
21393
21394 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21395 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021396 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021397
21398 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021399 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021400 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21401 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21402 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21403 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21404 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021405
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021406
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214079. Supported filters
21408--------------------
21409
21410Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21411accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21412unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21413
21414See also : "filter"
21415
214169.1. Trace
21417----------
21418
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021419filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021420
21421 Arguments:
21422 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21423 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21424
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021425 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021427 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021428 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21429 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21430 amount of the parsed data.
21431
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021432 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021433
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021434This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21435callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21436information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21437filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21438
21439Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21440tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21441a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21442
21443
214449.2. HTTP compression
21445---------------------
21446
21447filter compression
21448
21449The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21450keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021451when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21452fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21453done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21454explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21455filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21456listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21457order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021458
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021459See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21460 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021461
21462
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214639.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21464--------------------------------------------
21465
21466filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21467
21468 Arguments :
21469
21470 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21471 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21472 parsed.
21473
21474 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21475 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21476 part must be placed in its own scope.
21477
21478The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21479external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021480streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021481exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21482also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21483
21484SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21485the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21486
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021487For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021488"doc/SPOE.txt".
21489
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214909.4. Cache
21491----------
21492
21493filter cache <name>
21494
21495 Arguments :
21496
21497 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21498
21499The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21500"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021501cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021502other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21503case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21504is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21505filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021506listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21507order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021508
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021509See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21510 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21511
21512
215139.5. Fcgi-app
21514-------------
21515
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021516filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021517
21518 Arguments :
21519
21520 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21521
21522The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21523request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21524reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21525used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21526implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21527used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21528fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21529used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21530order.
21531
21532See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21533 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21534
21535
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215369.6. OpenTracing
21537----------------
21538
21539The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21540HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21541of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21542Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21543
21544This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21545
21546The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21547HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21548participates in the work of HAProxy.
21549
21550filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21551
21552 Arguments :
21553
21554 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21555 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21556 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21557 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21558 OpenTracing filters.
21559
21560 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21561 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21562 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21563 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21564 filter must have its own scope defined.
21565
21566More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021567of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021568
21569
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002157010. FastCGI applications
21571-------------------------
21572
21573HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21574feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21575the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21576FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21577servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21578FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21579backend.
21580
21581HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21582application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21583connection.
21584
2158510.1. Setup
21586-----------
21587
2158810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21589--------------------------
21590
21591fcgi-app <name>
21592 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21593 document root must be defined.
21594
21595acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21596 Declare or complete an access list.
21597
21598 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21599 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21600 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21601 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21602 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21603
21604docroot <path>
21605 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21606 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21607 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21608
21609index <script-name>
21610 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21611 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21612 is an optional setting.
21613
21614 Example :
21615 index index.php
21616
21617log-stderr global
21618log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021619 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021620 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21621
21622 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21623 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21624
21625pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21626 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21627 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21628 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21629
21630 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21631 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21632 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21633 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21634
21635 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21636 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21637
21638path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021639 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021640 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21641 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21642 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21643 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21644 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21645 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21646 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021647
21648 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021649 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021650 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21651 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21652 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21653 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021654
21655 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021656 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21657 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021658
21659option get-values
21660no option get-values
21661 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21662
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021663 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021664 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21665
21666 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21667 application will accept.
21668
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021669 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21670 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021671
21672 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021673 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021674 option is disabled.
21675
21676 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21677 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21678 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21679 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21680 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21681 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21682
21683option keep-conn
21684no option keep-conn
21685 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21686 sending a response.
21687
21688 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21689 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21690
21691option max-reqs <reqs>
21692 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21693 accept.
21694
21695 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21696 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21697 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21698 to 1.
21699
21700option mpxs-conns
21701no option mpxs-conns
21702 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21703
21704 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21705 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21706
21707set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21708 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21709 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21710 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21711 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21712
21713 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21714 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21715 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21716
21717 Example :
21718 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21719 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21720
21721 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21722
21723
2172410.1.2. Proxy section
21725---------------------
21726
21727use-fcgi-app <name>
21728 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21729
21730 Arguments :
21731 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21732
21733 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21734 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21735 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21736 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21737 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21738
21739 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21740 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21741 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21742 application are evaluated.
21743
21744
2174510.1.3. Example
21746---------------
21747
21748 frontend front-http
21749 mode http
21750 bind *:80
21751 bind *:
21752
21753 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21754 default_backend back-static
21755
21756 backend back-static
21757 mode http
21758 server www A.B.C.D:80
21759
21760 backend back-dynamic
21761 mode http
21762 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21763 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21764
21765 fcgi-app php-fpm
21766 log-stderr global
21767 option keep-conn
21768
21769 docroot /var/www/my-app
21770 index index.php
21771 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21772
21773
2177410.2. Default parameters
21775------------------------
21776
21777A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21778the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021779script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021780applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21781
21782 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21783 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21784 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21785 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21786 | | |
21787 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21788 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21789 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21790 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21791 | | application. |
21792 | | |
21793 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21794 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21795 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21796 | | |
21797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21798 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21799 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21800 | | the application's configuration. |
21801 | | |
21802 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21803 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21804 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21805 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21806 | | |
21807 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21808 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21809 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21810 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21811 | | be defined. |
21812 | | |
21813 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21814 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21815 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21816 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21817 | | is not set too. |
21818 | | |
21819 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21820 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21821 | | set. |
21822 | | |
21823 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21824 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21825 | | the request. |
21826 | | |
21827 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21828 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21829 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21830 | | |
21831 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21832 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21833 | | script to process the request. |
21834 | | |
21835 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21836 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21837 | | |
21838 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21839 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21840 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21841 | | |
21842 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21843 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21844 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21845 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21846 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21847 | | |
21848 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21849 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21850 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21851 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21852 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21853 | | side. |
21854 | | |
21855 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21856 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21857 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21858 | | connected to. |
21859 | | |
21860 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21861 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21862 | | |
21863 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21864 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21865 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21866 | | |
21867 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21868
21869
2187010.3. Limitations
21871------------------
21872
21873The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21874way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21875during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21876establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21877application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21878or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21879message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21880these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21881and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21882
21883Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21884request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21885requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21886
21887About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21888into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21889fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21890"http-request" ones.
21891
21892Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21893FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21894processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21895must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21896here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021897
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021898
2189911. Address formats
21900-------------------
21901
21902Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21903address.
21904
21905This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21906The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21907of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21908equivalent is '::'.
21909
21910Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21911is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21912
21913This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21914family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21915
21916Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21917configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21918use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21919'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21920
21921Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21922socket type and the transport method.
21923
21924
2192511.1 Address family prefixes
21926----------------------------
21927
21928'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21929
21930'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21931 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21932 listening.
21933
21934'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21935 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21936 on the statement using this address, a port or
21937 a port range may or must be specified.
21938
21939'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21940 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21941 using this address, a port or a port range
21942 may or must be specified.
21943
21944'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21945 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21946 using this address, a port or a port range
21947 may or must be specified.
21948
21949'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21950 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21951 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21952 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21953 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21954 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21955
21956'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21957 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21958 start by slash '/'.
21959
21960
2196111.2 Socket type prefixes
21962-------------------------
21963
21964Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21965type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21966this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21967This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21968but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21969
21970Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21971instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21972
21973If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21974they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21975report this to the maintainers.
21976
21977'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21978 to "stream"
21979
21980'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21981 to "datagram".
21982
21983
2198411.3 Protocol prefixes
21985----------------------
21986
21987'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21988 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21989 socket type and transport method is forced to
21990 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21991 this address, a port or a port range can or
21992 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21993 of 'stream+ip@'.
21994
21995'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21996 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21997 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21998 statement using this address, a port or port
21999 range can or must be specified.
22000 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22001
22002'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22003 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22004 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22005 statement using this address, a port or port
22006 range can or must be specified.
22007 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22008
22009'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22010 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22011 socket type and transport method is forced to
22012 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22013 this address, a port or a port range can or
22014 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22015 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22016
22017'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22018 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22019 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22020 the statement using this address, a port or
22021 port range can or must be specified.
22022 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22023
22024'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22025 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22026 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22027 the statement using this address, a port or
22028 port range can or must be specified.
22029 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22030
22031'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22032 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22033 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22034
22035'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22036 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22037 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22038
22039In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22040QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022042/*
22043 * Local variables:
22044 * fill-column: 79
22045 * End:
22046 */